Official Software
Get notified when we add a new MaseratiOther Model Manual

We cover 60 Maserati vehicles, were you looking for one of these?

Maserati - Ghibli - Workshop Manual - (2016)
Maserati Biturbo Service Manual PDF
Maserati Maserati Ghibli Maserati Ghibli Workshop Manual Service
Maserati - Granturismo - Workshop Manual - 2015 - 2015
Maserati Maserati Ghibli Maserati Ghibli Workshop Manual Maintenance
Maserati Maserati Quattroporte Maserati Quattroporte Workshop Manual Service
Maserati - GranTurismo - Owners Manual - (2012)
Maserati Maserati Biturbo Maserati Biturbo 1982 1992 Workshop Manual
Maserati Maserati Granturismo Maserati Granturismo 2009 Owners Manual
Maserati - Ghibli - Parts Catalogue - 2015 - 2015
Maserati Maserati Quattroporte Maserati Quatroparte Workshop Manual V6 2.0 and 2.8
Maserati Maserati Merak Maserati Merak Workshop Manual
Maserati Maserati 4200 Maserati 4200 2004 Owners Manual
Maserati Maserati Quattroporte Maserati Quattroporte 2008 Owners Manual
Maserati - Granturismo - Owners Manual - 2015 - 2015
Maserati Maserati Quattroporte Maserati Quattroporte Workshop Manual Engine Overhaul
Maserati - Ghibli - Workshop Manual - (2019)2
Maserati Maserati Granturismo Maserati Granturismo 2008 Owners Manual French
Maserati Maserati Indy Maserati Indy Workshop Manual
Maserati Maserati Granturismo Maserati Granturismo 2011 Owners Manual Italian
Maserati - GranTurismo - Owners Manual - (2009)
Maserati Maserati Quattroporte Maserati Quattroporte 2014 Owners Manual Italian
Maserati Maserati Spyder Maserati Spyder 2004 Owners Manual
Maserati Maserati Quattroporte Maserati Quattroporte 2011 Owners Manual Italian
Maserati Maserati Ghibli Maserati Gibli 2013 Owners Manual
Maserati Maserati Gransport Maserati Gransport 2006 Owners Manual Spyder
Maserati Maserati 3200 Maserati 3200 1998 Misc Documents Brochure
Maserati Maserati Ghibli Maserati Ghibli Misc Documents Parts Catalogue
Maserati - Granturismo - Workshop Manual - (2019)2
Maserati Maserati Quattroporte Maserati Quattroporte 2009 Owners Manual
Maserati - Ghibli - Owners Manual - 2014 - 2017
Maserati Maserati Ghibli Maserati Ghibli Owners Manual
Maserati Maserati Quattroporte Maserati Quattroporte Workshop Manual Fuel System
Maserati Maserati Merak Maserati Merak Owners Manual
Maserati - Quattroporte - Owners Manual - (2004)
Maserati Maserati Indy Maserati Indy Owners Manual
Maserati - Ghibli - Owners Manual - 2015 - 2015
Maserati Maserati Granturismo Maserati Granturismo 2012 Owners Manual Italian
Maserati - Ghibli - Owners Manual - 2015 - 2015 (2)
Maserati - Granturismo - Sales Brochure - 2008 - 2008
Maserati Maserati Quattroporte Maserati Quattroporte Misc Documents Tech Data
Maserati Maserati Quattroporte Maserati Quattroporte Owners Manual
Maserati Maserati Gransport Maserati Gransport 2005 Owners Manual
Maserati - Biturbo - Sales Brochure - 1982 - 1982
Maserati Maserati Ghibli Maserati Ghibli Misc Documents Range
Maserati - GranCabrio - Sales Brochure - 2014 - 2014 (2)
Maserati - Ghibli - Owners Manual - (2014)1
Maserati Maserati Merak Maserati Merak Misc Documents Parts Catalogue
Maserati Maserati Granturismo Maserati Granturismo 2014 Owners Manual Italian
Maserati Maserati 222 Maserati 222 Owners Manual Italian
Maserati - Indy - Parts Catalogue - 1970 - 1975
Maserati - 3200 - Miscellaneous Documents - 2010 - 2010
Maserati - Ghibli - Sales Brochure - 2014 - 2014 (4)
Maserati Maserati Granturismo Maserati Granturismo Misc Documents Range
Maserati - Ghibli - Sales Brochure - 2017 - 2017
Maserati - Biturbo - Miscellaneous Documents - 2010 - 2010
Maserati Maserati Granturismo Maserati Granturismo 2012 Misc Documents Brochure
Maserati Maserati Spyder Maserati Spyder Misc Documents Brochure
Maserati Maserati 3200 Maserati 3200 1999 Misc Documents Brochure
Maserati - Ghibli - Miscellaneous Documents - 2015 - 2015
Summary of Content
CODE 01/07/16/5000 99011M68P04-74E Service Division MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED Palam Gurgaon Road, Gurgaon - 122 015 (Haryana) www.marutisuzuki.com OWNER’S MANUAL & SERVICE BOOKLET • Keep With Vehicle At All Times • Contains Important Information On Safety, Operation & Maintenance Part No. 99011M68P04-74E July, 2016 ENG This Owner Manual & Service Booklet applies to the BALENO series produced by MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED July, 2016 Part No. 99011M68P04-74E For 24 X 7 assistance, contact Toll Free number 1800 200 6392# © COPYRIGHT MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED 2016 Note: The illustrated model is one of the BALENO Series. (NEXA) Celerio Pankaj Narula Executive Director (Service) Dear Sir/Madam, Thank you for choosing a Maruti Suzuki vehicle. I hope our dealership team took good care while delivering the vehicle to you. Celerio Your vehicle is equipped with state-of-the-art technologies. To get the best performance from your vehicle (and ensure it is trouble-free), kindly get your vehicle serviced periodically, as per the maintenance schedule in your Owner's Manual. Please make sure the service is done at a Maruti Suzuki authorized workshop for best results. For any accessories that you wish to fit on to your vehicle, please contact any of our authorized dealers for assistance. Kindly appreciate that any tampering of wiring harness to fit accessories may cause the vehicle to malfunction. Thank you once again for choosing a Maruti Suzuki vehicle. I wish you many years of safe and happy driving. Yours sincerely Celerio MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED Palam Gurgaon Road, Gurgaon-122015 www.marutisuzuki.com (Pankaj Narula) “WARNING” Vehicle may break-down, meet with an accident or catch fire due to 1. Installation of - High wattage bulbs - Non genuine lamps / horns - Modified suspension / wheels - Non genuine parts / accessories etc. 2. Retrofitment of LPG / CNG fuel systems/kits. 3. Usage of domestic LPG. 4. Short circuiting due to tampering of wiring harness. CAUTION: DO NOT STORE OR CARRY INFLAMMABLE MATERIALS IN THE VEHICLE. Avoid driving into or starting the vehicle in a heavily water logged area. Vehicle may breakdown or engine may fail due to 1. Water entry into the engine. 2. Short circuiting of the electrical systems. If the vehicle is stuck in deep water, do not start / crank the vehicle until the level of water drops below the level of exhaust pipe. NOTE: IF THE VEHICLE IS SUBMERGED IN WATER, REPORT AUTHORIZED WORKSHOP. TO THE NEAREST VIN: MODEL: OWNER NAME & ADDRESS VARIANT: COLOUR: ENGINE NO.: CONTACT NO. KEY NO.: E-mail ID: INVOICE DATE: ODOMETER READING KM REGISTRATION NO.: SELLING DEALER NAME & CODE BATTERY MAKE: DEALER SHOWROOM ADDRESS & CONTACT NO. (STAMP) BATTERY NO.: BATTERY BATCH TYRE MAKE BATCH CODE Front Right Front Left Rear Right CONTACT NO. FOR SERVICE APPOINTMENT & SUPPORT Rear Left Spare For any assistance with regard to our product, please contact General Manager/Works Manager at any of our authorised Maruti Suzuki Nexa dealer/authorised Maruti Suzuki Workshop. For additional enquiry you may contact our Regional Office or Service Department. The addresses and phone numbers are given in Service Network section of this Manual / Service Network booklet. MAINTENANCE SERVICE RECORDS DATE OF SERVICE KIND OF SERVICE MILEAGE (KM) DESCRIPTION OF JOB NAME OF SERVICING DEALER/ MASS JOB CARD NO. MECHANICS SIGNATURE F: .... FREE SERVICE, P:.... PAID SERVICE, W:.... WARRANTY JOB, A:.... ACCIDENTAL JOB 68PH0-74E (CUSTOMER’S COPY) (1,000 KM or 1 MONTH) WHICHEVER COMES FIRST JOB MARK: √ : Checked OK, A: Adjust, C: Clean, R: Replace or Change, L: Lubricate, T: Tighten, O: Rotate, I: Inspect and correct or replace if necessary (DEALER’S COPY) (1,000 KM or 1 MONTH) Please see overleaf for special instructions Model Code* (1) Engine Coolant (Level, Leakage) (2) Engine Oil (Level, Leakage) (3) Cooling System hoses & connections (Leakage, Damage) (1) Fuel filter, Fuel tank cap, Fuel lines and connections (Leakage) (2) Fuel Filter - Water Draining (Diesel) 1. Clutch Pedal (Play) (Petrol) 2. Clutch Slipping (Dragging, Damage) 3. Transmission Oil (Level, Leakage) 4. Gear Shifter Cable (Operation) 5. Clutch fluid (Level, Leakage) (Diesel) (1) Brake fluid (Level, Leakage) (2) Brake Pedal (Pedal to Carpet Clearance) (3) Parking brake lever (Play) (4) Brake hoses & pipes (Leakage, Damage) (1) Tyres (Air pressure, Abnormal wear, Damage) (2) Wheels (Inspect) (1) Steering wheel (Play) (2) All Rods & Arms (Loose, Damage, Wear) (3) Power Steering System (Operation) (4) Steering gear box (Inspect) (5) Tilt/Telescopic (if equipped) steering (Operation) (1) Battery electrolyte (Level, Leakage) (2) Lighting System / Horn (Operation) (3) Wiper (Operation) Chassis No. : Engine No. : Mileage Date of Invoice Date of Inspection Registration No. (1) All Latches, Hinges & Locks / Central Locking (Operation) HEATING AND AIR-CONDITIONING (1) Drive belt (Tension) (2) Check functioning of Recirculating flap (3) Check all Hose Joints (4) A/C filter element (Inspect) Service Dealer Code/Mass Code Customer Name Address (Please write complete address) (1) Operation of Brakes, clutch, Gear shifting and Speedometer (2) Body & Chassis noise (1) Struts / Shock Absorbers (Oil leakage) (2) Rear spring (Damage) Mechanic’s Signature COST OF MATERIALS AND CONSUMABLES TO BE BORNE BY CUSTOMER Service Manager’s Signature * Model Code: Baleno (Petrol) : A1K412 Baleno (Diesel) : A1K413D Customer’s Signature Model Code* Chassis No. : Engine No. : Mileage Date of Invoice Date of Inspection Registration No. Service Dealer/Mass Code Customer Name Address (Please write complete address) For Servicing Dealer/Mass Mechanic’s Signature Service Manager’s Signature Customer’s Signature (CUSTOMER’S COPY) (5,000 KM or 6 MONTHS) WHICHEVER COMES FIRST JOB MARK: √ : Checked OK, A: Adjust, C: Clean, R: Replace or Change, L: Lubricate, T: Tighten, O: Rotate, I: Inspect and correct or replace if necessary (DEALER’S COPY) (5,000 KM or 6 MONTHS) Please see overleaf for special instructions Model Code* 1. Engine Coolant (Level, Leakage) 2. Engine Oil (Level, Leakage) 3. Cooling System hoses & connections (Leakage, Damage) 4. Exhaust System (Noise, Leakage) 5. PCV System (Hoses, Connections, Valve) 1. Air cleaner (Clean) (Petrol) 2. Fuel Filter, Fuel tank cap, Fuel lines and connection (Leakage) 3. Fuel filter water draining (Diesel) 1. Clutch Pedal (Play) (Petrol) 2. Clutch Slipping (Dragging, Damage) 3. Transmission Oil (Level, Leakage) 4. Gear Shifter Cable (Operation) 5. Drive shaft boots (Damage) 6. Clutch fluid (Level, Leakage) (Diesel) 1. Brake fluid (Level, Leakage) 2. Brake Pedal (Pedal to Carpet Clearance) 3. Parking brake lever (Play) 4. Brake Disc and pad (Inspect) 5. Brake hoses & pipes (Leakage, Damage) 1. Tyres (Air pressure, Abnormal wear, Rotation) 2. Wheels (Inspect) 3. Front / Rear wheel Bearing (Loose, Damage) 1. Suspension Struts/Shock Absorbers (Oil leakage) 2. Suspension arms, Knuckle, Rear spring (Damage, Loose) 3. All nuts & Bolts (Tighten) Chassis No. : Engine No. : Mileage 1. Steering wheel (Play) 2. All Rods & Arms (Loose, Damage, Wear) 3. Power Steering System (Operation) 4. Steering gear box (Inspect) 5. Tilt / Telescopic (if equipped) steering (Operation) 1. Battery electrolyte (Level, Leakage) 2. Lighting System/Horn (Operation) 3. Wiring Harness Connections (Looseness) 4. Wiper (Operation) Date of Invoice Date of Inspection Registration No. Service Dealer/Mass Code 1. All Latches, Hinges & Locks/Central Locking (Operation/Lubrication) 2. All Chassis nuts & Bolts (Inspect) 3. Seat belt (Operation) 4. Seat latch, lever & knob (Operation) HEATING AND AIR-CONDITIONING 1. Drive belt (Tension, Damage) 2. Check functioning of Recirculating flap 3. Check all Hose Joints 4. Tighten Compressor Mounting Bolts 5. Clean Condenser with low pressure water 6. A/C filter element (Inspect) Mechanic’s Signature Service Manager’s Signature Customer’s Signature 1. Operation of Brakes, clutch, Gear shifting and Speedometer 2. Body & Chassis noise COST OF MATERIALS AND CONSUMABLES TO BE BORNE BY CUSTOMER * Model Code: Baleno (Petrol) : A1K412 Baleno (Diesel) : A1K413D Model Code* Chassis No. : Engine No. : Mileage Date of Invoice Date of Inspection Registration No. Service Dealer/Mass Code For Servicing Dealer/Mass Mechanic’s Signature Service Manager’s Signature Customer’s Signature (CUSTOMER’S COPY) (10,000 KM or 12 MONTHS) WHICHEVER COMES FIRST JOB MARK: √ : Checked OK, A: Adjust, C: Clean, R: Replace or Change, L: Lubricate, T: Tighten, O: Rotate, I: Inspect and correct or replace if necessary (DEALER’S COPY) (10,000 KM or 12 MONTHS) Please see overleaf for special instructions Model Code* 1. Engine Coolant (Level, Leakage) 2. Cooling System hoses & connections (Leakage, Damage) 3. Engine Oil & Oil filter (Replace) 4. Cylinder head bolts (Tight) (Petrol) 5. Engine Mounting and Manifold Fixing (Noise, Leakage, Damage etc.) 1. Air cleaner filter element (Clean) 2. Fuel Filter, Fuel tank cap, Fuel lines and connection (Leakage) 3. Fuel filter - water draining (Diesel) 1. Clutch Pedal (Play) (Petrol) 2. Clutch Slipping (Dragging, Damage) 3. Transmission Oil (Level, Leakage) 4. Gear Shifter Cable (Operation) 5. Drive shaft boots (Damage) 6. Clutch fluid (Level, Leakage) (Diesel) 1. Brake fluid (Level, Leakage) 2. Brake Pedal (Pedal to Carpet Clearance) 3. Parking brake lever (Play) 4. Brake Disc & Pads (Inspect) 5. Brake hoses & pipes (Leakage, Damage) 6. Brake Drums & Shoes (Inspect) 1. Tyres (Air pressure, Abnormal wear, Rotation) 2. Wheels (Inspect) 3. Front / Rear wheel Bearing (Loose, Damage) 1. Suspension Struts/Shock Absorbers (Oil leakage) 2. Suspension arms, Knuckle, Rear spring (Damage, Loose) 3. All nuts & Bolts (Tighten) Chassis No. : Engine No. : Mileage 1. Steering wheel (Play) 2. All Rods & Arms (Loose, Damage, Wear) 3. Power Steering System (Operation) 4. Steering gear box (Inspect) 5. Tilt/Telescopic (if equipped) steering (Operation) 1. Battery electrolyte (Level, Leakage) 2. Lighting System/horn (Operation) 3. Wiring Harness Connections (Looseness) 4. Wiper (Operation) Date of Invoice Date of Inspection Registration No. Service Dealer/Mass Code 1. All Latches, Hinges & Locks/Central Locking (Operation/Lubrication) 2. All Chassis nuts & Bolts (Inspect) 3. Seat belt (Operation) 4. Seat latch, lever & knob (Operation) HEATING AND AIR-CONDITIONING 1. Drive belt (Tension, Damage) 2. Check functioning of Recirculating flap 3. Check all Hose Joints 4. Tighten Compressor Mounting Bolts 5. Clean Condenser with low pressure water 6. A/C filter element (Inspect) 1. Operation of Brakes, clutch, Gear shifting and Speedometer 2. Body & Chassis noise COST OF MATERIALS AND CONSUMABLES TO BE BORNE BY CUSTOMER Mechanic’s Signature Service Manager’s Signature Customer’s Signature * Model Code: Baleno (Petrol) : A1K412 Baleno (Diesel) : A1K413D Model Code* Chassis No. : Engine No. : Mileage Date of Invoice Date of Inspection Registration No. Service Dealer/Mass Code For Servicing Dealer/Mass Mechanic’s Signature Service Manager’s Signature Customer’s Signature FOREWORD This manual is an essential part of your vehicle and should remain with the vehicle when resold or otherwise transferred to a new owner or operator. Please read this manual carefully before operating your new MARUTI SUZUKI and review the manual from time to time. It contains important information on safety, operation and maintenance. You are invited to avail the three Free Inspection Services as described in the manual. Three free inspection coupons are attached to this manual. Please show this manual to your dealer while you take your MARUTI SUZUKI for any Service. To prolong the life of your vehicle and reduce maintenance cost, the periodic maintenance must be carried out according to “PERIODIC MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE” described in “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section of this manual. It is essential for preventing trouble and accidents to ensure your satisfaction and safety. Daily inspection and care as per “DAILY INSPECTION CHECKLIST” described in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section of this manual is essential for prolonging the life of the vehicle and for safe driving. MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED believes in conservation and protection of Earth’s natural resources. To that end, we encourage every vehicle owner to recycle, trade-in or properly dispose of, as appropriate, used Engine Oil, coolant and other fluids, batteries and tyres etc. MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED All information in this manual is based on the latest product information available at the time of publication. Due to improvements or other changes, there may be discrepancies between information in this manual and your vehicle. MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED reserves the right to make production changes at any time, without notice and without incurring any obligation to make the same or similar changes to vehicles previously built or sold. This vehicle may not comply with standards or regulations of other countries. Before attempting to register this vehicle in any other country, check all applicable regulations and make any necessary modifications. 1 68PH0-74E IMPORTANT MODIFICATION ING WARNING/ CAUTION/NOTICE/ NOTE Please read this manual and follow its instructions carefully. To emphasize special information, the symbol and the words WARNING, CAUTION, NOTICE and NOTE have special meanings. Pay particular attention to messages highlighted by these signal words: WARNING WARNING Indicates a potential hazard that could result in death or serious injury. CAUTION Indicates a potential hazard that could result in minor or moderate injury. NOTICE Indicates a potential hazard that could result in vehicle damage. NOTE: Indicates special information to make maintenance easier or instructions clearer. WARN- 75F135 The circle with a slash in this manual means “Don’t do this” or “Don’t let this happen”. Do not modify your vehicle. Modification could adversely affect safety, handling, performance, or durability and may violate governmental regulations. In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from modification may not be covered under warranty. NOTICE Improper installation of mobile communication equipment such as cellular telephones, CB (Citizen’s Band) radios or any other wireless transmitters may cause electronic interference with your vehicle’s ignition system, resulting in vehicle performance problems. Consult your MARUTI SUZUKI dealer or qualified service technician for advice. NOTICE Severe damage may be caused by the use of either poor quality fuel and/or lubricants not recommended by MARUTI SUZUKI. 2 68PH0-74E WARRANTY POLICY (4) Limitation: This warranty shall not apply to: Maruti Suzuki India Limited (hereinafter called “Maruti Suzuki”), warrants that each new Maruti Suzuki vehicle distributed in India by Maruti Suzuki and sold by an authorised Maruti Suzuki NEXA dealer will be free, under normal use and service, from any defects in material and workmanship at the time of manufacture SUBJECT TO THE FOLLOWING TERMS AND CONDITIONS: (1) Qualification: To qualify for this warranty: The Maruti Suzuki vehicle must be delivered by authorised Maruti Suzuki NEXA dealer and serviced by authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. (2) Term: The term of the warranty shall be twenty-four (24) months or 40,000 kilometers (whichever occurs first) from the date of invoice to the first owner. (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (3) Maruti Suzuki Warranty Obligation: If any defect(s) should be found in a Maruti Suzuki vehicle within the term stipulated above, Maruti Suzuki’s only obligation is to repair or replace at its sole discretion any part shown to be defective, with a new part or the equivalent at no cost to the owner for parts or labour, when Maruti Suzuki acknowledges that such a defect is attributable to faulty material or workmanship at the time of manufacture. The owner is responsible for any repair or replacements which are not covered by this warranty. (g) (h) (i) (j) (k) Normal maintenance service required other than the three free services, including without limitation, oil and fluid changes, headlight aiming, fastener retightening, wheel balancing, wheel alignment and tyre rotation, cleaning of injectors, adjustments of carburettor, ignition timing, clutch and valve clearance. The replacement of normal wear parts including without limitation, bulbs, tyres and tubes, spark plugs, belts, hoses, filters, wiper blades, brushes, contact points, fuses, clutch disc, brake shoes, brake pads, cable and all rubber parts (except oil seal and glass run). Any vehicle which has been used for competition or racing. Any repairs or replacement required as a result of accidents or collision. Any defects caused by misuse, negligence, abnormal use or insufficient care. Any vehicle which has been modified or altered, including without limitation, the installation of performance accessories. Any vehicle on which parts or accessories not approved by Maruti Suzuki have been used. Any vehicle which has not been operated in accordance with the operating instructions in this Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet. Any vehicle which has not received, during the warranty term, the service inspections prescribed in this Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet. Any vehicle which has been assembled, disassembled, adjusted or repaired by other than authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Any vehicle which has been used for purposes other than what it was designed for. 3 68PH0-74E (l) (m) (n) (o) (p) (q) Any damage or deterioration caused by industrial pollution and bird droppings. Insignificant defects which do not affect the function of the vehicle including without limitation, sound, vibration and fluid seep. Any natural wear and tear including without limitation, aging etc. Installation and usage of domestic LPG gas/LPG Cylinder. V-belts, hoses and gas leaks. Any vehicle retrofitted with LPG/CNG kits. (5) Extent of Warranty: This warranty is the entire written warranty given by Maruti Suzuki for Maruti Suzuki vehicles and no dealer or its or his agent or employee is authorised to extend or enlarge this warranty and no dealer or its or his agent or employee is authorised to make any oral warranty on Maruti Suzuki’s behalf. Maruti Suzuki reserves the right to add any improvements or change the design of any model at any time with no obligation to make the same changes on units previously sold. (6) Warranty Service: – Make certain that the authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop has certified the work on the “Maintenance Service Record” page in the “Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet and – Present the Maruti Suzuki “Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet to the authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop whenever requesting service inspections or warranty service. If the “Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet” should be lost or destroyed the owner should consult the authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop from whom the vehicle was purchased for instructions concerning replacement of the “Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet”. (8) Disclaimer of Consequential Damage: Maruti Suzuki assumes no responsibility for loss of vehicle, loss of time, inconvenience or any other indirect incidental or consequential damage resulting from the vehicle not being available to the owner because of any defect covered by this warranty. (9) Change of Owner Even if ownership of the vehicle changes, the remaining warranty period is effective for the new owner. To obtain warranty service, the complete vehicle must be presented at the owner’s expenses to any authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. (7) Owner’s Warranty Responsibilities: It is responsibility of each owner to: – Have performed, at his own expenses, by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop all the service inspections specified in the Maruti Suzuki “Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet and maintain adequate proof that such service inspections have been performed. 4 68PH0-74E EMISSION WARRANTY POLICY Maruti Suzuki offers the Emission Warranty on all Maruti Suzuki vehicles (apart from the Regular Warranty and will run parallel to the regular product warranty) only in four metropolitan cities (New Delhi, Kolkata, Mumbai and Chennai) with effect from July 1st, 2001. Terms: The Emission Warranty will be applicable for 80,000 kms or 3 years (Whichever comes earlier) from the date of invoice to the first owner. The remaining warranty terms will be valid in case of any change in ownership provided the production of all valid documents. Conditions: 1. Under Emission Warranty, Warranty claims will be admitted for a prima-facie examination, in case vehicle fails to meet the Emission Standard as specified in sub rule (2) of rule no. 115 of Central Motor Vehicles Rules (CMVR), 1989. 2. The warranty claims will only be accepted after examination carried out by Maruti Suzuki or authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop which leads to firm conclusions that the a) Original settings have not been tampered in any case. b) Part (as given in Annexure - A) has a manufacturing defect. c) Vehicle is unable to meet the Emission Standards (as given in 1.), inspite of the vehicle having been maintained and used in accordance with the instructions as specified in Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet and the used fuel and different oils (Engine oil, Transmission oil, Brake oil etc.) are also as per specification. 3. The method of examination for deciding the warranty of the parts will be at the sole discretion of Maruti Suzuki and authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop and results of the examination will be final and binding. If after examination, the warrantable condition is not established, Maruti Suzuki and authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop has the right to charge all, or part of the cost of such examination. 4. Under Emission Warranty, the parts (as given in Annexure - A) will be changed free of cost, but the consumables will be charged as per actual. 5. If the part covered under Emission Warranty or the associated parts, are not independently replaceable, on account of these being integral parts of a complete assembly, Maruti Suzuki and authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop will have the sole discretion to replace either the entire assembly or by using some of the parts of the system through suitable repairs or modifications. 6. Any consequential repairs or replacement of parts which may be found necessary to establish compliance of Emission Warranty, will not be considered under warranty, unless the same is under product warranty. The consumable will be charged as per actual under such repair or replacement. 7. Maruti Suzuki will not be responsible for the cost of transportation of the vehicle to the nearest authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop or any loss due to non-availability of the vehicle during the period of lodging of a warranty claim and examination and/or repair by Maruti Suzuki workshop. 8. Maruti Suzuki will not be responsible for any penalty that may be charged by statutory authorities on account of failure to comply with the EMISSION STANDARDS. 9. Emission Warranty will not be affected by the change of owner, provided all the documents are available. 5 68PH0-74E 10. All maintenance actions (as specified in the Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet) need to be followed and recorded in the manual for emission warranty. 11. The customer needs to produce the PUC (Pollution Under Control) certificate valid for the period preceding the test during which the failure is discovered. The receipts (for the maintenance of the vehicle as per specification in Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet from the date of original purchase of the vehicle) will also be required. Conditions under which the Emission Warranty is not APPLICABLE 1. In the absence of valid PUC certificate. 2. Vehicle not serviced from authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as per the schedule specified in the Owner’s Manual. 3. Vehicle subjected to abnormal use (accident, motor race, rallies or for the purpose of establishing the records etc). 4. Use of non MGP (Maruti Genuine Part). 5. Vehicle that has been tampered with. 6. Tampering with odometer so that the actual kilometer reading cannot be determined. 7. Use of adulterated fuel and/or unspecified oils (Engine oil, Transmission oil and Brake oil etc). Annexure - A List of parts covered under Emission Warranty 1. Fuel Injection Assembly, Pressure Regulator, Throttle Body Assembly. 2. Electronic Control Module (ECM). 3. Intake Manifold. 4. EGR valve. 5. Ignition Coil. 6. Canister Assembly. 7. Vapour Liquid Seperator. 8. Fuel Tank and Filler Cap. 9. PCV (Positive Crankcase Ventilation) Valve. 10. Oil Filler Cap. 11. Catalytic Convertor. 12. Exhaust Manifold. 13. All Fuel Injection System related SENSORS. 14. High Pressure Fuel Pump. 15. Glow Plug. 16. Glow Plug Controller. 6 68PH0-74E TABLE OF CONTENTS FUEL RECOMMENDATION 1 BEFORE DRIVING 2 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE 3 DRIVING TIPS 4 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT 5 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE 7 EMERGENCY SERVICE 8 APPEARANCE CARE 9 GENERAL INFORMATION 10 SPECIFICATIONS 11 76MH1-74E FUEL RECOMMENDATION FUEL RECOMMENDATION S 1 Fuel Recommendation ........................................................ 1-1 68PH0-74E FUEL RECOMMENDATION Fuel Recommendation Petrol Engine You must use unleaded petrol with an octane number (RON) of 91 or higher. Petrol/Ethanol blends Blends of unleaded petrol and ethanol (grain alcohol), also known as gasohol, are commercially available in some areas. Blends of this type may be used in your vehicle if they are no more than 10% ethanol. Make sure this petrol-ethanol blend has octane ratings no lower than those recommended for petrol. Petrol/Methanol blends Blends of unleaded petrol and methanol (wood alcohol) are also commercially available in some areas. DO NOT USE fuels containing more than 5% methanol under any circumstances. Fuel system damage or vehicle performance problems resulting from the use of such fuels are not the responsibility of MARUTI SUZUKI and may not be covered under the New Vehicle Warranty. Fuels containing 5% or less methanol may be suitable for use in your vehicle if they contain cosolvents and corrosion inhibitors. NOTE: If you are not satisfied with the driveability or fuel economy of your vehicle when you are using a petrol/alcohol blend, you should switch back to unleaded petrol containing no alcohol. NOTICE The fuel tank has an air space to allow for fuel expansion in hot weather. If you continue to add fuel after the filler nozzle has automatically shut off or an initial blowback occurs, the air chamber will become full. Exposure to heat when fully fuelled in this manner will result in leakage due to fuel expansion. To prevent such fuel leakage, stop filling after the filler nozzle has automatically shut off, or when using an alternative non-automatic system, initial vent blowback occurs. NOTICE Be careful not to spill fuel containing alcohol while refueling. If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body, wipe it up immediately. Fuels containing alcohol can cause paint damage, which is not covered under the New Vehicle Warranty. 1-1 68PH0-74E FUEL RECOMMENDATION Diesel Engine You must use diesel fuel with Cetane Number (CN) higher than 51 and sulfur content less than 350 ppm (parts per million). MARUTI SUZUKI recommends to use the diesel fuel conformable to EN590. Do not use marine diesel fuel, heating oils and so forth. NOTICE NOTICE Be careful not to spill fuel containing alcohol while refueling. If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body, wipe it up immediately. Fuels containing alcohol can cause paint damage, which is not covered under the New Vehicle Warranty. The fuel tank has an air space to allow for fuel expansion in hot weather. If you continue to add fuel after the filler nozzle has automatically shut off or an initial blowback occurs, the air chamber will become full. Exposure to heat when fully fuelled in this manner will result in leakage due to fuel expansion. To prevent such fuel leakage, stop filling after the filler nozzle has automatically shut off, or when using an alternative non-automatic system, initial vent blowback occurs. 1-2 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING BEFORE DRIVING Keys ......................................................................................2-1 Door Locks ...........................................................................2-2 Keyless Push Start System Remote Controller/ Keyless Entry System Transmitter ....................................2-5 Security System (if equipped) ............................................2-15 Theft Deterrent Light (if equipped) .....................................2-19 Windows ...............................................................................2-19 Mirrors ..................................................................................2-22 Front Seats ...........................................................................2-25 Rear Seats ............................................................................2-27 Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems ............................2-29 Child Restraint System For India.........................................2-41 Supplemental Restraint System (air bags) ........................2-44 Instrument Cluster (Type A) (if equipped) ........................ 2-51 Speedometer ....................................................................... 2-52 2 Fuel Gauge ........................................................................... 2-52 Brightness Control .............................................................. 2-53 Information Display ............................................................. 2-53 Instrument Cluster (Type B) (if equipped) ........................ 2-60 Speedometer ....................................................................... 2-61 Tachometer .......................................................................... 2-61 Fuel Gauge ........................................................................... 2-61 Temperature Gauge ............................................................ 2-62 Brightness Control .............................................................. 2-62 Information Display ............................................................. 2-63 Instrument Cluster (Type C) (if equipped) ........................ 2-72 Speedometer ....................................................................... 2-73 Tachometer .......................................................................... 2-73 Fuel Gauge ........................................................................... 2-73 Temperature Gauge ............................................................ 2-74 Brightness Control .............................................................. 2-74 Information Display ............................................................. 2-75 Warning and Indicator Lights ............................................ 2-95 Lighting Control Lever ....................................................... 2-102 Headlight Leveling Switch ................................................ 2-108 Turn Signal Control Lever ................................................ 2-108 Hazard Warning Switch ..................................................... 2-109 Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever ............................... 2-110 Tilt/Telescoping (if equipped) Steering Lock Lever ......... 2-112 Horn ..................................................................................... 2-112 Heated Rear Window Switch (if equipped) ....................... 2-113 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Keys Immobilizer System EXAMPLE 54G489 Your vehicle comes with a pair of identical keys. Keep the spare key in a safe place. One key can open all of the locks on the vehicle. The key identification number is stamped on a metal tag provided with the keys or on the keys. Keep the tag (if equipped) in a safe place. If you lose your keys, you will need this number to have new keys made. Write the number below for your future reference. KEY NUMBER: This system is designed to help prevent vehicle theft by electronically disabling the engine starting system. The engine can be started only with your vehicle’s original immobilizer ignition key or keyless push start system remote controller which has an electronic identification code programmed into it. The key or remote controller communicates the identification code to the vehicle when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”. If you need to make spare keys or remote controllers, see your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. The vehicle must be programmed with the correct identification code for the spare. A key made by an ordinary locksmith will not work. For vehicles without keyless push start system If this light blinks, turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” position, then turn it back to the “ON” position. If the light still blinks after the ignition switch is turned back to the “ON” position, there may be something wrong with your key or with the immobilizer system. Ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to have the system inspected. For vehicles with keyless push start system If this light blinks, change the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF), then change back to “ON”. Also refer to “If the master warning indicator light blinks and the engine cannot be started” in “Starting the Engine (Vehicle with Keyless Push Start System)” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. If the light still blinks after the ignition mode is changed back to “ON”, there may be something wrong with your key or with the immobilizer system. Ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to have the system inspected. 80JM122 If the immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light blinks when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position or the ignition mode is “ON”, the engine will not start. 2-1 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING The immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light may also blinks if the remote controller is not in the vehicle when you close the door or attempt to start the engine. NOTE: • If you lose your immobilizer ignition key or remote controller, see your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible to have the lost one deactivated, then have the new key or remote controller made by them. • If you own other vehicles with immobilizer keys, keep those keys away from the ignition switch or the engine switch when using your Vehicle, or the engine may not be started because they may interfere with your vehicle’s immobilizer system. • If you attach any metal objects to the immobilizer key or remote controller, it may not start the engine. NOTICE The immobilizer key and remote controller are sensitive electronic instruments. To avoid damaging them: • Do not expose them to impacts, moisture or high temperature such as on the dashboard under direct sunlight. • Keep them away from magnetic objects. Ignition Key Reminder (if equipped) A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind you to remove the ignition key if it is in the ignition switch when the driver’s door is opened. Door Locks Side Door Locks (1) (2) (3) (4) 68PH00201 (1) (2) (3) (4) LOCK UNLOCK Front Rear To lock a driver’s door from outside the vehicle: • Insert the key and turn the top of the key toward the front of the vehicle, or • Turn the lock knob forward, then pull and hold the door handle as you close the door. To unlock a driver’s door from outside the vehicle, insert the key and turn the top of the key toward the rear of the vehicle. 2-2 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Central Door Locking System EXAMPLE (1) (1) (2) (2) (3) NOTE: You can switch the function that unlocks all doors from twice operations to once operation, and vice versa, via the setting mode of the information display. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information Display” in this section. To unlock the driver’s door only, insert the key in that door lock and turn the top of the key toward the rear of the vehicle once. EXAMPLE (4) (1) 68PH00202 (1) LOCK (2) UNLOCK To lock a door from inside the vehicle, turn the lock knob forward. Turn the lock knob rearward to unlock the door. To lock a rear door from outside the vehicle, turn the lock knob forward and close the door. You do not need to pull and hold the door handle as you close the door. NOTE: Be sure to hold the door handle when you close a locked front door, or the door will not remain locked. (2) 68PH00203 (1) (2) (3) (4) LOCK UNLOCK Front Rear You can lock and unlock all doors (including the tailgate) simultaneously by using the key in the driver’s door lock. To lock all doors simultaneously, insert the key in the driver’s door lock and turn the top of the key toward the front of the vehicle once. To unlock all doors simultaneously, insert the key in the driver’s door lock and turn the top of the key toward the rear of the vehicle twice. 68PH00204 (1) LOCK (2) UNLOCK You can also lock or unlock all doors by depressing the front or rear of the switch, respectively. 2-3 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING NOTE: • You can also lock or unlock all doors by operating the transmitter or remote controller. Refer to “Keyless Push Start System Remote Controller/Keyless Entry System Transmitter” in this section. • If your vehicle is equipped with the keyless push start system, you can also lock or unlock all doors by pushing the request switch. Refer to “Keyless Push Start System Remote Controller/Keyless Entry System Transmitter” in this section. NOTE: • All doors are automatically unlocked when you change the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF) or turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” position and pull out the key. • All doors are automatically locked for safety when the vehicle speed reaches 15 km/h. • You can change the automatic locking or unlocking function mentioned above via the setting mode of the information display. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information Display” in this section. Child-Proof Locks (rear door) Tailgate EXAMPLE (1) (2) (1) EXAMPLE 68PH00205 (1) LOCK (2) UNLOCK 68PH00206 (1) Tailgate unlatch switch Each of the rear doors is equipped with a child-proof lock which can be used to help prevent unwanted opening of the door from inside the vehicle. When the lock lever is in the “LOCK” position (1), the rear door can only be opened from outside. When the lock lever is in the “UNLOCK” position (2), the rear door can be opened from inside or outside. WARNING Be sure to place the child-proof lock in the “LOCK” position whenever children are seated in the rear. You can lock and unlock the tailgate by using the key in the driver’s door lock. To open the tailgate, push and hold the tailgate unlatch switch (1) and lift the tailgate. NOTE: When the tailgate is closed incompletely, follow the procedure below: 1) Push the tailgate unlatch switch (1) and open the tailgate. 2) After a few seconds, close the tailgate. 3) Make sure that the tailgate is closed completely. 2-4 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Keyless Push Start System Remote Controller/Keyless Entry System Transmitter WARNING Always make sure that the tailgate is closed and latched securely. Completely closing the tailgate helps prevent occupants from being thrown from the vehicle in the event of an accident. Completely closing it also helps keep exhaust gases from entering the vehicle. If you cannot unlatch the tailgate by pushing the unlatch switch (1) due to a discharged battery or malfunction, follow the procedures below to unlatch the tailgate from inside the vehicle. 1) Remove the luggage compartment cover and fold the rear seat forward for easier access. Refer to “Folding Rear Seats” section for details on how to fold the rear seat forward. 2) To approach the emergency lever, remove the trim of the tailgate. (2) (3) Type A Type B 68PH00207 3) Open the cover (2), and then, move the emergency lever (3) to the direction of the arrow with a flat blade screwdriver as shown in the illustration. 4) Push open the tailgate from inside. The tailgate will be latched again by simply closing the tailgate. If the tailgate cannot be unlatched by pushing the unlatch switch (1), have the vehicle inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 68PH00270 Your vehicle is equipped with either a keyless push start system remote controller (Type A) or a keyless entry system transmitter (Type B). The remote controller has a keyless entry system and a keyless push start system. The transmitter has only a keyless entry system. For details, refer to the following explanations. CAUTION Make sure there is no one near the tailgate when pushing open the tailgate from inside the vehicle. 2-5 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING WARNING Radio waves from the keyless push start system antenna(s) may interfere with operation of electrical medical equipment such as pacemakers. Failure to take the precautions listed below can increase the risk of severe injury or death due to radio wave interference. • Anyone who uses electrical medical equipment such as a pacemaker should consult the medical equipment supplier or their medical advisor about whether radio waves from the antenna(s) can interfere with the medical equipment. • If radio wave interference is a concern, have the function of the antenna(s) disabled by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Keyless Push Start System Remote Controller (Type A) The remote controller enables the following operations: • You can lock or unlock the doors by operating the LOCK/UNLOCK buttons on the remote controller. Refer to the explanation in this section. • You can lock or unlock the doors by pushing the request switch. For details, refer to the explanation in this section. • You can start the engine without using an ignition key. For details, refer to “Engine Switch” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. (2) (1) 68PH00208 (1) “LOCK” button (2) “UNLOCK” button You can lock or unlock all doors (including the tailgate) simultaneously by operating the remote controller near the vehicle. 2-6 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Central door locking system • To lock all doors, push the “LOCK” button (1) once. • To unlock only the driver’s door, push the “UNLOCK” button (2) once. • To unlock other doors, push the “UNLOCK” button (2) once again. NOTE: You can switch the function that unlocks all doors from twice operations to once operation, and vice versa, via the setting mode of the information display. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information Display” in this section. The turn signal lights will flash once and the siren will sound once when the doors are locked. When the doors are unlocked: • The turn signal lights will flash twice and the siren will sound twice. • If the interior light switch is in the “DOOR” position, the interior light will turn on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. If you press the engine switch during this time, the light will start to fade out immediately. Be sure the doors are locked after you operate the “LOCK” button (1). If no door is opened within about 30 seconds after the “UNLOCK” button (2) is operated, the doors will automatically lock again. Panic alarm function This function is to get the attention of others. Push both of the “LOCK” button (1) and “UNLOCK” button (2) for more than 3 seconds. The turn signal lights will blink for about 27.5 seconds. Also, the siren will sound for about 27.5 seconds at the same time. To cancel the panic alarm, press any button (LOCK or UNLOCK). You can also cancel the panic alarm in any of the following operations. • Press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to ON. • Bring the remote controller with you and press the request switch. NOTE: The panic alarm function will not activate when the ignition mode is “ACC” or “ON”. NOTE: • If you lock the doors using the remote controller when the engine hood are open, the siren will sound 3 times to remind you. • If the security system was triggered due to an unauthorized entry into the vehicle and then you unlock the doors using the remote controller, the siren will sound 4 times to remind you. If this happens, check whether your vehicle has been broken into while you were away from it. • Once you push both of the “LOCK” button (1) and “UNLOCK” button (2), then you push one of the buttons within 5 seconds, the siren will not sound. However, If you push one of the buttons twice within 5 seconds, or push one of the buttons 5 seconds later, the siren will sound. • You can set whether the siren sounds when locking or unlocking the door(s) via the setting mode of the information display. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information Display” in this section. 2-7 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING NOTE: • The maximum operating distance of the remote controller is about 5 m (16 ft.), but this can vary depending on the surroundings, especially near other transmitting devices such as radio towers or CB (Citizen’s Band) radios. • The door locks cannot be operated with the remote controller if the ignition mode is other than the “LOCK” (OFF). • If any door is open, you cannot lock the door by operating the remote controller, however unlock the door. • If you lose one of the remote controllers, ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible for a replacement. Be sure to have your dealer program the new remote controller code in your vehicle’s memory so that the old code is erased. Keyless unlocking/locking using the request switches To unlock a door or all doors: • Push one of the request switches once to unlock only one door. • Push one of the request switches twice to unlock all doors. NOTE: You can switch the function that unlocks all doors from twice operations to once operation, and vice versa, via the setting mode of the information display. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information Display” in this section. EXAMPLE (1) 68PH00209 When the remote controller is within the operating range described in this section, you can lock or unlock the doors (including the tailgate) by pushing the request switch (1) on the driver’s door handle, front passenger’s door handle or tailgate. To lock all doors when all doors are unlocked: • To lock all doors, push one of the request switches once. When the doors are unlocked: • The turn signal lights will flash twice and the exterior siren will sound twice. • If the interior light switch is in the “DOOR” position, the interior light will turn on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. If you press the engine switch during this time, the light will start to fade out immediately. Be sure the doors are locked after you operate the request switch to lock the doors. The turn signal lights will flash once and the exterior siren will sound once when the doors are locked. 2-8 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING NOTE: • The door locks cannot be operated by the request switch under the following conditions: – If any door is open or is not completely closed. – If the ignition mode is other than “LOCK” (OFF). • If no doors are opened within about 30 seconds after unlocking the doors by pushing the request switch, the doors will be locked again automatically. EXAMPLE (1) (1) (1) 68PH00210 (1) 80 cm (2 1/2 feet) When the remote controller is within approximately 80 cm (2 1/2 feet) from a front door handle or the tailgate switch, you can lock or unlock the doors by pushing the request switch. NOTE: • If the remote controller is outside the request switch operating range described above, you will not be able to operate the request switch. • If the battery of the remote controller runs down or there are strong radio waves or noise, the request switch operating range may be reduced or the remote controller may be inoperative. • If the remote controller is too close to the door glass, the request switches may not operate. • If a spare remote controller is in the vehicle, the request switches may not operate normally. • The remote controller will only operate a request switch if it is within the switch’s operating range. For example, if the remote controller is within the operating range of the driver’s door request switch but not the front passenger’s door request switch or the tailgate request switch, the driver’s door switch can be operated but the front passenger’s door switch or tailgate switch cannot be operated. NOTICE The remote controller is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging the remote controller: • Do not expose it to impacts, moisture or high temperature such as by leaving it on the dashboard under direct sunlight. • Keep the remote controller away from magnetic objects such as a television. NOTE: The keyless push start system may not function correctly in certain environments or under certain operating conditions such as the following: • When there are strong signals coming from a television, power station or a cellular phone. • When the remote controller is in contact with or covered by a metal object. • When a radio wave type remote keyless entry is used nearby. • When the remote controller is placed near an electronic device such as personal computer. Some additional precautions you should take and information you should be aware of are: • Make sure the key is stowed in the remote controller. If the remote controller becomes unreliable, you will not be able to lock or unlock the doors. 2-9 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING • Be sure that the driver always carries the remote controller. • If you lose one of the remote controllers, ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible for a replacement. Be sure to have your dealer program the new remote controller code in your vehicle’s memory so that the old code is erased. • You can use up to four remote controllers and the keys for your vehicle. Ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for details. • The battery life of the remote controller is about two years, but it can vary depending on usage conditions. 68PH00211 To stow the key into the remote controller, push the key in the remote controller until you hear a click. Press the request switch again after doing the following: With the ignition mode changed to “LOCK” (OFF) by pressing the engine switch, bring out the remote controller if it is inside the vehicle and check that all doors are completely closed. (A) Reminder function 68PH00212 To remove the key from the remote controller, push the button (A) in the direction of the arrow and pull the key out from the remote controller. Request switch warning buzzer This exterior buzzer beeps for about 2 seconds in the following conditions to warn you that the request switch is not working: • The request switch is pressed after all doors are closed with the ignition mode changed to “ACC” or “ON” by pressing the engine switch. • The request switch is pressed in any of the following conditions after changing the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF) by pressing the engine switch. – The remote controller is left inside the vehicle. – Any door (including the tailgate) is open. EXAMPLE 68PH00213 If the remote controller is not in the vehicle under the following conditions, the buzzer sounds intermittently for about 2 seconds and the immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light on the instrument cluster blinks: When one or more doors are opened and all of the doors are later closed with the ignition mode is other than “LOCK”. 2-10 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING The indicator light will turn off within several seconds after the remote controller is returned to an area of the vehicle other than the rear luggage area. If the remote controller is left in the vehicle and you lock the driver’s door or front passenger’s door as described below, the door will be automatically unlocked. • If you open the driver’s door and lock the door by turning the lock knob forward or pushing the power door locking switch, the driver’s door will be automatically unlocked. • If you open the front passenger’s door and lock the door by turning the lock knob forward or pushing the power door locking switch, the front passenger’s door will be automatically unlocked. NOTE: • The reminder will not operate when the remote controller is on the instrument panel, in the glove box, in a storage compartment, in the sun visor or on the floor etc. • Be sure that the driver always carries the remote controller. • Do not leave the remote controller in the vehicle when leaving the vehicle. Replacement of the battery If the remote controller becomes unreliable, replace the battery. To replace the battery of the remote controller: (1) 68PH00214 (1) Lithium disc type battery: CR2032 or equivalent 71LMT0201 1) Pull the key out from the remote controller. 2) Insert a flat blade screwdriver covered with a soft cloth in the slot of the remote controller and pry it open. 3) Replace the battery (1) so its + terminal faces the bottom of the case as shown in the illustration. 4) Close the remote controller firmly. 5) Make sure the door locks can be operated with the remote controller. 6) Dispose of the used battery properly according to applicable rules or regulations. Do not dispose of lithium batteries with ordinary household trash. 2-11 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING WARNING Keyless Entry System Transmitter (Type B) Swallowing a lithium battery may cause serious internal injury. Do not allow anyone to swallow a lithium battery. Keep lithium batteries away from children and pets. If swallowed, contact a physician immediately. NOTE: You can switch the function that unlocks all doors from twice operations to once operation, and vice versa, via the setting mode of the information display. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information Display” in this section. NOTICE The remote controller is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging it, do not expose it to dust or moisture or tamper with internal parts. NOTE: Used batteries must be disposed properly according to applicable rules or regulations and must not be disposed with ordinary household trash. (1) Central door locking system • To lock all doors, push the “LOCK” button (1) once. • To unlock only the driver’s door, push the “UNLOCK” button (2) once. • To unlock other doors, push the “UNLOCK” button (2) once again. (2) 68PH00215 (1) “LOCK” button (2) “UNLOCK” button You can lock or unlock all doors (including the tailgate) simultaneously by operating the transmitter near the vehicle. The turn signal lights will flash once and the siren will sound once when the doors are locked. When the doors are unlocked: • The turn signal lights will flash twice and the siren will sound twice. • If the interior light switch is in the “DOOR” position, the interior light will turn on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. If you insert the key into the ignition switch during this time, the light will start to fade out immediately. Be sure the doors are locked after you operate the “LOCK” button (1). If no door is opened within about 30 seconds after the “UNLOCK” button (2) is operated, the doors will automatically lock again. 2-12 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING NOTE: • If you lock the doors using the transmitter when the engine hood is open, the siren will sound 3 times to remind you. • If the security system was triggered due to an unauthorized entry into the vehicle and then you unlock the doors using the transmitter, the siren will sound 4 times to remind you. If this happens, check whether your vehicle has been broken into while you were away from it. • Once you push both of the “LOCK” button (1) and “UNLOCK” button (2), then you push one of the buttons within 5 seconds, the siren will not sound. However, If you push one of the buttons twice within 5 seconds, or push one of the buttons 5 seconds later, the siren will sound. • You can set whether the siren sounds when locking or unlocking the door(s) via the setting mode of the information display. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information Display” in this section. NOTE: • The maximum operating distance of the keyless entry system transmitter is about 5 m (16 ft.), but this can vary depending on the surroundings, especially near other transmitting devices such as radio towers or CB (Citizen’s Band) radios. • The door locks cannot be operated with the transmitter, if the ignition key is inserted in the ignition switch. • If any door is open, you cannot lock the door by operating the transmitter, however unlock the door. • If you lose one of the transmitters, ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible for a replacement. Be sure to have your dealer program the new transmitter code in your vehicle’s memory so that the old code is erased. Panic alarm function This function is to get the attention of others. Push both of the “LOCK” button (1) and “UNLOCK” button (2) for more than 3 seconds. The turn signal lights will blink for about 27.5 seconds. Also, the siren will sound for about 27.5 seconds at the same time. To cancel the panic alarm, press any button (LOCK or UNLOCK). You can also turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position to cancel the panic alarm. NOTE: The panic alarm function will not activate when the key is in the ignition switch. NOTICE The transmitter is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging the transmitter: • Do not expose it to impacts, moisture or high temperature such as by leaving it on the dashboard under direct sunlight. • Keep the transmitter away from magnetic objects such as a television. 2-13 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Replacement of the battery If the transmitter becomes unreliable, replace the battery. WARNING (2) Swallowing a lithium battery may cause serious internal injury. Do not allow anyone to swallow a lithium battery. Keep lithium batteries away from children and pets. If swallowed, contact a physician immediately. To replace the battery of the transmitter: (1) (3) NOTICE (2) 68PH00217 (3) Lithium disc type battery: CR1616 or equivalent 68PH00216 1) Remove the screw (1), and open the transmitter cover. 2) Remove the transmitter (2). 3) Put the edge of a flat blade screwdriver in the slot of the transmitter (2) and pry it open. 4) Replace the battery (3) so its + terminal faces the “+” mark of the transmitter. 5) Close the transmitter and install it into the transmitter holder. 6) Close the transmitter cover, install and tighten the screw (1). 7) Make sure the door locks can be operated with the transmitter. 8) Dispose of the used battery properly according to applicable rules or regulations. Do not dispose of lithium batteries with ordinary household trash. The transmitter is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging it, do not expose it to dust or moisture or tamper with internal parts. NOTE: Used batteries must be disposed properly according to applicable rules or regulations and must not be disposed with ordinary household trash. 2-14 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Security System (if equipped) The security system is armed in about 5 seconds after you lock all doors (including the tailgate) by using the keyless entry system transmitter, keyless push start system remote controller or request switch. Once the system is armed, any attempt to open a door by using any other means (*) than the keyless entry system transmitter, keyless push start system remote controller or open the engine hood, will cause the alarm to be triggered. * These means include the following: – The key – The lock knob on a door – The central door locking switch – The tailgate emergency lever Also, in case that you have set the shock sensor to enabled state and set sensitivity of the pre-warning function and full blast warning function to a level other than 0, the alarm will be triggered if any attempt to tamper with the vehicle. The shock sensor can be selected enabled or disabled state, and sensitivity of each warning can be adjusted as desired. To set the shock sensor, ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop or use the setting mode of the information display. NOTE: • The default setting of the shock sensor is in the disabled state. Set to the enabled state and adjust sensitivity of each warning according to your preference. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information Display” in this section. • Your dealer may have already set the shock sensor of the vehicle to the enabled state before you purchase it. Consult your dealer for further information. NOTE: • The security system generates alarms when any of the predetermined conditions is met. However, the system does not have any function of blocking unauthorized entry into the vehicle. • Always use the keyless entry system transmitter or keyless push start system remote controller to unlock the doors when the security system has been armed. Using a key instead will trigger the alarm. • If a person who does not know the security system is going to drive the vehicle, we recommend you explain the system and its operation to the person, or disable the system beforehand. Mistakenly triggering the alarm may cause a nuisance to others. • Even if the security system is armed, you should still be careful to guard against theft. Do not leave money or things of value in the vehicle. How to arm the security system (when enabled) Lock all doors (including the tailgate) using the keyless entry system transmitter or keyless push start system remote controller. The security system indicator (1) will start blinking rapidly, and the security system will be armed in about 5 seconds. While the system is being armed, the indicator continues to blink at intervals of approximately 2 seconds. (1) EXAMPLE 68PH00218 2-15 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING NOTE: • To prevent the alarm from being accidentally triggered, avoid arming it while anyone remains inside the vehicle. The alarm will be triggered if any person inside opens the door, tailgate, engine hood, or swings the vehicle (if the shock sensor is in the enabled state). • The security system is not armed when all doors are locked using the key from outside, using the door lock knobs or the central door locking switch from inside. • If any door is not operated within approximately 30 seconds after the doors have been unlocked using the keyless entry system transmitter or keyless push start system remote controller, the doors are automatically locked again. When the doors are locked, the security system will be armed in about 5 seconds if the system is in the enabled state. • If the security system indicator (1) blinks when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position or the ignition mode is “ON”, there may be something wrong with the security system. Ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to inspect the system. How to disarm the security system Simply unlock the doors using the keyless push start system remote controller, the request switch or the keyless entry system transmitter. The security system indicator will go out, indicating that the security system is disarmed. How to stop the alarm Should the alarm be triggered accidentally, the alarm will stop by the following operations. • Press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “ON” or turn the ignition switch to “ON” position. • Unlock the doors using the keyless push start system remote controller, the request switch, or the keyless entry system transmitter. NOTE: • Even after the alarm has stopped, if you lock the doors using the keyless entry system transmitter or keyless push start system remote controller, the security system will be rearmed with a delay of about 5 seconds. • If you disconnect the battery while the security system is in the armed condition or the alarm is actually in operation, the alarm will be re-triggered when the battery is then reconnected. • Even after the alarm has stopped at the end of the predetermined operation time, it will be triggered again if any of the doors, tailgate or engine hood is opened, or the vehicle feels a shock (if the shock sensor is in the enabled state), without disarming the security system. Checking whether the alarm has been triggered during parking If the alarm was triggered and you then turn the ignition switch to “ON” position or the ignition mode is “ON”, the security system indicator will blink rapidly for about 8 seconds and a buzzer will beep 4 times during this period. If this happens, check whether the vehicle has been broken into while you were away from it. Enabling and disabling the security system The security system can be either enabled or disabled. 2-16 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING When enabled • If any of the doors or tailgate are opened without unlocking by the keyless entry system transmitter or keyless push start system remote controller, all turn signal lights start to blink and the interior buzzer beeps intermittently. After 5 seconds, the siren will sound for about 27.5 seconds. The security system indicator continues to blink during this time. • If the engine hood is opened, all turn signal lights blink, and the siren sounds for about 27.5 seconds. The security system indicator continues to blink during this time. (If the shock sensor is in the enabled state) • If the vehicle feels a shock higher than the pre-warning sensitivity, the siren sounds for about 2 seconds (pre-warning). If the vehicle feel a shock higher than the full blast warning sensitivity, all turn signal lights start to blink and the interior buzzer beeps intermittently. After 5 seconds, the siren will sound for about 27.5 seconds (full blast warning). The security system indicator continues to blink during this time. NOTE: If you set the full blast warning sensitivity higher than the pre-warning sensitivity in the setting mode of the information display, or the vehicle feels such shock as to be able to trigger the full blast warning, the full blast warning will be triggered preferentially. In this case, the pre-warning will not be triggered. EXAMPLE (1) (2) When disabled When the system is disabled, it stays disarmed even if you perform any system arming operation. 68PH00219 How to switch the state of the security system When the security system has been already disarmed, you can switch the system from the enabled state to the disabled state, and vice versa, using the following method. 2) (Vehicle with keyless push start system only) Turn the lock knob (1) on the driver’s door rearward (2). EXAMPLE 1) Sit in the driver’s seat and make sure that all doors, tailgate and engine hood are closed. •If any door is open, the open door warning light comes on. (3) 68PH00220 2-17 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING 3) Turn the knob on the lighting control lever to the OFF position (3). (4) 3 times (6) NOTE: The following steps 4) and 5) must be completed within 15 seconds. EXAMPLE (5) 4 times EXAMPLE 68PH00222 5) Push the lock end (4) (forward end) of the central door locking switch (5), and then push the unlock end (6) (backward end). Repeat this operation 3 times. OFF 68PH00221 4) Turn the knob on the lighting control lever to the position and then turn back to the OFF position. Repeat this operation 4 times. Every time you perform the series of the above steps, the state of the security system changes from the currently selected one to the other. You can check whether the system is enabled or disabled by the number of interior buzzer beeps at the end of the procedure as follows. System state Number of beeps Disabled Once Enabled 4 times • If you cannot complete the operations in step 4) and 5) within 15 seconds correctly, the state of the security system will not change and the interior buzzer does not beep. Perform the procedure again from the beginning. NOTE: You can also switch the security system from the enabled state to the disabled state, and vice versa, via the setting mode of the information display. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information Display” in this section. 2-18 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Theft Deterrent Light (if equipped) Windows Electric Window Controls The electric windows can only be operated when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position or the ignition mode is “ON”. Manual Window Control (if equipped) EXAMPLE Driver’s side (Type A) EXAMPLE (1) (2) EXAMPLE 68PH00223 This light will blink with the ignition switch in the “LOCK” or “ACC” position. The blinking light is intended to deter theft by leading others to believe that the vehicle is equipped with a security system. 60G010 Raise or lower the door windows by turning the handle located on the door panel. 68PH00224 2-19 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Passenger’s door Driver’s side (Type B) EXAMPLE EXAMPLE CLOSE (1) (4) OPEN (2) (5) (3) 68PH00225 68PH00226 The driver’s door has a switch (1) to operate the driver’s window, and a switch (2) to operate the front passenger’s window or there are switches (3), (4), to operate the rear left and right passenger windows, respectively. The passenger’s door has a switch (5) to operate the passenger’s window. 81A009 To open a window, push the top part of the switch and to close the window lift up the top part of the switch. The driver’s window has “auto-down” and “auto-up” (if equipped) features for added convenience (at toll booths or drivethrough restaurants, for example). This means the driver can open or close the window without holding the window switch in the “Down” or “Up” position. Press down or lift up the driver’s window switch completely and release it. To stop the window before it reaches the full-down or full-up position, pull up or push down the switch briefly. 2-20 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Lock switch EXAMPLE 68PH00227 The driver’s door also has a lock switch for the passenger’s window(s). When you push in the lock switch, the passenger’s window(s) cannot be raised or lowered by operating any of the switches (2), (3), (4) or (5). To restore normal operation, release the lock switch by pushing again. WARNING • You should always lock the passenger’s window operation when there are children in the vehicle. Children can be seriously injured if they get part of their body caught by the window during operation. • To avoid injuring an occupant by window entrapment, be sure no part of the occupant’s body such as hands or head is in the path of the electric windows when closing them. • Always remove the ignition key or take the keyless push start system remote controller with you when leaving the vehicle even if only for a short time. Also do not leave children alone in a parked vehicle. Unattended children could use the electric window switches and get trapped by the window. Pinching Prevention Function (if equipped) The driver’s window is equipped with the pinching prevention function. The function detects a foreign object caught in the window while being closed by the “auto-up” feature, by which you can close the window without holding the window switch in the “Up” position, and stops the window closing to prevent damage. WARNING To avoid injuring an occupant by window entrapment, be sure no part of the occupant’s body such as hands or head is in the path of the electric window when closing it. The function may not detect the object depending on size, hardness, and position of the object caught by the closing window. NOTE: If you drive with one of the rear windows open, you may hear a loud sound caused by air vibration. To reduce the sound, open the driver’s or front passenger’s window, or narrow the rear window opening. 2-21 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING CAUTION • The pinching prevention function does not act while you are holding the window switch in the “Up” position. • The pinching prevention function may not detect an object caught in the window just before the window is fully closed. NOTE: Even if you cannot close the window by the auto-up feature because there may be something wrong with the pinching prevention function, you can close the window by holding the window switch in the “Up” position. If you drive in extreme off-road condition, the pinching prevention function may operate accidentally because the window react to vehicle jolting. The Pinching Prevention Function Initialization When you disconnect and re-connect the battery or replace the fuse, the function will be deactivated. In this condition, the autodown feature will be deactivated, while the auto-up feature may remain being activated. The pinching prevention function needs to be initialized. To initialize the pinching prevention function, use the following procedure: 1) Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position or press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “ON”. 2) Open the driver’s window fully by holding the window switch in the “Down” position. 3) Close the driver’s window by holding the switch in the “Up” position, and keep holding the switch for 2 seconds after the window fully closed. 4) Check the driver’s window if the autodown/up feature work. Mirrors Inside Rearview Mirror 68LMT0205 WARNING Whenever you disconnect and reconnect the battery or replace the fuse, the pinching prevention function needs to be reinitialized. The pinching prevention function will not be activated until the initialization complete. If the auto-down/up feature would not work after initialization, there might be something wrong with the pinching prevention function. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. (1) (2) (3) 68PH00228 (2) Day driving (3) Night driving You can adjust the inside rearview mirror by hand so as to see the rear of your vehicle in the mirror. To adjust the mirror, set the selector tab (1) to the day position, then move the mirror up, down or sideways by hand to obtain the best view. 2-22 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING When driving at night, you can move the selector tab to the night position to reduce glare from the headlights of vehicles behind you. WARNING • Always adjust the mirror with the selector set to the day position. • Only use the night position if it is necessary to reduce glare from the headlights of vehicles behind you. Be aware that in this position you may not be able to see some objects that could be seen in the day position. Auto Dimming Rearview Mirror (if equipped) (1) You can adjust the auto dimming rearview mirror by hand so you can see to the rear of your vehicle in the mirror. This rearview mirror has a function of automatically reducing glare from the lights of vehicles behind you. The function works when the ignition mode has been changed to “ON” by pressing the engine switch. • The mirror is always set to the automatic dimming mode when the ignition mode is “ON”. • When the switch (2) is pushed, the green indicator (1) is lit, indicating that the mirror is set to the automatic dimming mode. To cancel the automatic dimming mode, push the switch (2); the indicator (1) then goes out. • The auto dimming rearview mirror is automatically deactivated while the gearshift lever is in the “R” position. (3) (3) 68PH00230 WARNING Do not touch or cover the sensor (3) since this may impair normal operation of the system. Blocking glare from the sensor with an object such as a shade, sticker, accessory or baggage may also impair proper operation of the system. NOTICE (2) Do not hook anything heavy on the mirror, or the mirror may break under the weight. 68PH00229 2-23 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Outside Rearview Mirrors Electric Mirrors (if equipped) EXAMPLE Outside Rearview Mirrors Folding Switch (if equipped) (1) EXAMPLE (3) EXAMPLE (1) (2) (4) (1) (2) (3) (4) 68PH00231 68PH00232 Adjust the outside rearview mirrors so you can just see the side of your vehicle in the mirrors. The switch to control the electric mirrors is located on the driver’s door panel. You can adjust the mirrors when the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position, or the ignition mode is “ACC” or “ON”. To adjust the mirrors: WARNING Be careful when judging the size or distance of a vehicle or other object seen in the side convex mirror. Be aware that objects look smaller and appear farther away than when seen in a flat mirror. 1) Move the selector switch to the left or right to select the mirror you wish to adjust. 2) Press the outer part of the switch that corresponds to the direction in which you wish to move the mirror. 3) Return the selector switch to the center position to help prevent unintended adjustment. 68PH00233 You can fold the mirrors when you park the vehicle in a narrow space. When the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position, or the ignition mode is “ACC” or “ON”, push the folding switch (1) to fold and unfold the mirrors. Make sure the mirrors are completely unfolded before you start driving. CAUTION Moving mirrors can pinch and injure a hand. Do not allow any one’s hand to get near the mirrors when folding and unfolding the mirrors. 2-24 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Front Seats Seat Adjustment WARNING Never attempt to adjust the driver’s seat or seatback while driving. The seat or seatback could move unexpectedly, causing loss of control. Make sure that the driver’s seat and seatback are properly adjusted before you start driving. WARNING To avoid excessive seat belt slack, which reduces the effectiveness of the seat belts as a safety device, make sure that the seats are adjusted before the seat belts are fastened. WARNING All seatbacks should always be in an upright position when driving, or seat belt effectiveness may be reduced. Seat belts are designed to offer maximum protection when seatbacks are in the upright position. 2-25 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Seat position adjustment lever (1) Pull the lever up and slide the seat. EXAMPLE Seatback angle adjustment lever (2) Pull the lever up and move the seatback. Seat height adjustment lever (3) (if equipped) Pull the lever up to raise the seat. Push the lever down to lower the seat. After adjustment, try to move the seat and seatback forward and rearward to ensure that it is securely latched. (2) (3) (1) 68PH00234 2-26 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Head Restraints NOTE: It may be necessary to recline the seatback to provide enough overhead clearance to remove the head restraint. Front Rear Seats Head Restraints (if equipped) Head restraints are designed to help reduce the risk of neck injuries in the case of an accident. WARNING EXAMPLE • Never drive the vehicle with the head restraints removed. • Do not attempt to adjust the head restraint while driving. NOTE: It may be necessary to fold forward the seatback to provide enough overhead clearance to remove the head restraint. 80J001 Head restraints are designed to help reduce the risk of neck injuries in the case of an accident. Adjust the head restraint to the position which places the center of the head restraint closest to the top of your ears. If this is not possible for very tall passengers, adjust the head restraint as high as possible. WARNING • Never drive the vehicle with the head restraints removed. • Do not attempt to adjust the head restraint while driving. 68PH00235 To raise the front head restraint, pull upward on the head restraint until it clicks. To lower the head restraint, push down on the head restraint while holding in the lock lever. If a head restraint must be removed (for cleaning, replacement, etc.), push in the lock lever and pull the head restraint all the way out. Adjust the head restraint to the position which places the center of the head restraint closest to the top of your ears. If this is not possible for very tall passengers, adjust the head restraint as high as possible. 2-27 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Folding Rear Seats Rear The rear seat(s) of your vehicle can be folded forward to provide additional cargo space. EXAMPLE To fold the rear seats forward: NOTICE After folding the rear seatback forward, do not allow any foreign material to enter the lock opening. This may cause damage to the inside of the lock and prevent the seatback from being locked securely. WARNING If you need to carry cargo in the passenger compartment with the rear seat back folded forward, be sure to secure the cargo or it may be thrown about, causing injury. Never pile cargo higher than the seatbacks. 68PH00236 To raise the rear head restraint, pull upward on the head restraint until it clicks. To lower the head restraint, push down on the head restraint while holding in the lock lever. If a head restraint must be removed (for cleaning, replacement, etc.), push in the lock lever and pull the head restraint all the way out. When installing a child restraint system, raise the head restraint to the most upper position. EXAMPLE 68PH00237 1) Pull up the release knob on the top of the seat(s), and fold the seatback forward. 2-28 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING To return the seat to the normal position, follow the procedure below. WARNING When returning the rear seatback to the normal position, make sure that there is nothing around the striker. Any foreign materials prevent the seatback from being locked securely. After returning the seat, try moving the seatback to make sure they are securely latched. Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems CAUTION Do not put your hand into the rear seatback lock opening, or your finger may get caught and be injured. NOTICE CAUTION When returning the rear seatback to the normal position, be careful that your finger is not caught between the lock and the striker. EXAMPLE 68PH00238 Raise the seatback until it locks into place. • When returning the rear seatback to the normal position, do not allow any foreign material to enter the lock opening. This may prevent the seatback from being locked securely. • When returning the rear seatback to the normal position, be sure to handle it carefully by hand to avoid any damage to the lock itself. Do not push it by using some material or by applying excessive force. • As the lock is designed exclusively for securing the rear seatback, do not use it for any other purpose. Incorrect use of it may cause damage to the inside of the lock and prevent the seatback from being locked securely. 68PM2001 WARNING Wear Your Seat Belts at All Times. WARNING An air bag supplements, or adds to, the frontal crash protection offered by seat belts. The driver and all passengers must be properly restrained by wearing seat belts at all times, whether or not an air bag is mounted at their seating position, to minimize the risk of severe injury or death in the event of a crash. 2-29 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Above the pelvis as low as possible across the hips Across the pelvis 65D606 WARNING • Never allow persons to ride in the cargo area of a vehicle. In the event of an accident, there is a much greater risk of injury for persons who are not riding in a seat with their seat belt securely fastened. • Seat belts should always be adjusted as follows: – the lap portion of the belt should be worn low across the pelvis, not across the waist. – the shoulder straps should be worn on the outside shoulder only, and never under the arm. – the shoulder straps should be away from your face and neck, but not falling off your shoulder. (Continued) 65D201 WARNING (Continued) • Seat belts should never be worn with the straps twisted and should be adjusted as tightly as is comfortable to provide the protection for which they have been designed. A slack belt will provide less protection than one which is snug. • Make sure that each seat belt buckle is inserted into the proper buckle catch. It is possible to cross the buckles in the rear seat. (Continued) 65D199 WARNING (Continued) • Pregnant women should use seat belts, although specific recommendations about driving should be made by the woman’s medical advisor. Remember that the lap portion of the belt should be worn as low as possible across the hips, as shown in the diagram. • Do not wear your seat belt over hard or breakable objects in your pockets or on your clothing. If an accident occurs, objects such as glasses, pens, etc. under the seat belt can cause injury. (Continued) 2-30 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING WARNING (Continued) • Never use the same seat belt on more than one occupant and never attach a seat belt over an infant or child being held on an occupant’s lap. Such seat belt use could cause serious injury in the event of an accident. • Periodically inspect seat belt assemblies for excessive wear and damage. Seat belts should be replaced if webbing becomes frayed, contaminated, or damaged in any way. It is essential to replace the entire seat belt assembly after it has been worn in a severe impact, even if damage to the assembly is not obvious. • Children age 12 and under should ride properly restrained in the rear seat. • Infants and small children should never be transported unless they are properly restrained. Restraint systems for infants and small children can be purchased locally and should be used. Make sure that the system you purchase meets applicable safety standards. Read and follow all the directions provided by the manufacturer. (Continued) WARNING (Continued) • For children, if the shoulder belt irritates the neck or face, move the child closer to the center of the vehicle. • Avoid contamination of seat belt webbing by polishes, oils, chemicals, and particularly battery acid. Cleaning may safely be carried out using mild soap and water. • Do not insert any items such as coins, clips, etc. into the seat belt buckles, and be careful not to spill liquids into these parts. If foreign materials get into a seat belt buckle, the seat belt may not work properly. • All seatbacks should always be in an upright position when driving, or seat belt effectiveness may be reduced. Seat belts are designed to offer maximum protection when seatbacks are in the upright position. Lap-Shoulder Belt Emergency locking retractor (ELR) The seat belt has an emergency locking retractor (ELR), which is designed to lock the seat belt only during a sudden stop or impact. It also may lock if you pull the belt across your body very quickly. If this happens, let the belt go back to unlock it, then pull the belt across your body more slowly. Rear outside seat belt guide (1) 68PH00271 2-31 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING WARNING If rear outside seat belt is fastened without unhooking the webbing from the belt guide (1), the seat belt does not show full performance in the event of accident and can result in serious personal injury. Unhook the webbing from the belt guide whenever the seat belt is fastened. Low on hips All Seat Belts Except Rear Center All seat belts except rear center are the lap-shoulder belt. Safety reminder 60A040 Sit up straight and fully back Low on hips To reduce the risk of sliding under the belt during a collision, position the lap portion of the belt across your lap as low on your hips as possible and adjust it to a snug fit by pulling the shoulder portion of the belt upward through the latch plate. The length of the diagonal shoulder strap adjusts itself to allow freedom of movement. 60A036 To fasten the seat belt, sit up straight and well back in the seat, pull the latch plate attached to the seat belt across your body and press it straight into the buckle until you hear a “click”. 60A038 2-32 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Lap Belt EXAMPLE Rear Center Seat Belt To fasten the belt, pull the latch plate attached to the seat belt across your hips and press it straight into the buckle until you hear a “click”. To reduce the risk of sliding under the belt during a collision, position the belt across your lap as low on your hips as possible and adjust it to a snug fit. TO TIGHTEN 80J2008 60A039 NOTE: The word “CENTER” is marked on the buckle for the rear center belt. The buckles are designed so a latch plate cannot be inserted into the wrong buckle. To unfasten the seat belt, push the red “PRESS” button on the buckle and retract the belt slowly while attaching a hand to the belt or/and the latch plate. Low on hips 80JS028 To tighten the belt, pull the free end of the belt across alongside the lap strap. 2-33 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING TO LOOSEN To unfasten the belt, press the release button on the buckle catch. Driver’s Seat Belt Reminder With tachometer EXAMPLE EXAMPLE Right angle 80JS029 To lengthen, release the latch plate from the buckle, pull the latch plate (adjuster) in the direction of the arrow, at right angles to the belt. The latch plate should then be refitted into the buckle and the belt tightened as previously described. 79MH0239 NOTE: The word “CENTER” is marked on the buckle for the rear center belt. The buckles are designed so a latch plate cannot be inserted into the wrong buckle. 68PH00239 Without tachometer EXAMPLE 68PH00240 2-34 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING When the driver does not buckle his or her seat belt, the driver’s seat belt reminder light in the instrument cluster will come on or brink and a buzzer will sound as a reminder to the driver to buckle his or her seat belt. For more details, refer to the explanation below. If the driver’s seat belt remains unbuckled when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”. The reminder works as follows: 1) The driver’s seat belt reminder light will come on. 2) After the vehicle’s speed has reached about 15 km/h, the driver’s seat belt reminder light will blink and a buzzer will sound for about 95 seconds. 3) After step 2) has finished, the reminder light will remain on until the driver’s seat belt is buckled. If the driver has buckled his or her seat belt and later unbuckles the seat belt, the reminder system will be activated from step 1) or step 2) according to the vehicle’s speed. When the vehicle’s speed is below about 15 km/h, the reminder will start from step 1). When the vehicle’s speed is above about 15 km/h, the reminder will start from step 2). The reminder will be automatically canceled when the driver’s seat belt is buckled or the ignition switch is turned off, or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF). WARNING Shoulder Anchor Height Adjuster (if equipped) EXAMPLE It is absolutely essential that the driver and passengers wear their seat belts at all times. Persons who are not wearing seat belts have a much greater risk of injury if an accident occurs. Make a regular habit of buckling your seat belt before putting the key in the ignition or pressing the engine switch. 68PH00241 Adjust the shoulder anchor height so that the shoulder belt rides on the center of the outboard shoulder. To move upward, slide the anchor up. To move downward, slide the anchor down while pulling the lock knob out. After adjustment, make sure that the anchor is securely locked. WARNING Be sure that the shoulder belt is positioned on the center of the outside shoulder. The belt should be away from your face and neck, but not falling off your shoulder. Misadjustment of the belt could reduce the effectiveness of the safety belt in a crash. 2-35 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Rear Outside Seat Belt Guide WARNING If rear outside seat belt is fastened without unhooking the webbing from the belt guide (1), the seat belt does not show full performance in the event of accident and can result in serious personal injury. Unhook the webbing from the belt guide whenever the seat belt is fastened. (1) Seat Belt Inspection EXAMPLE 68PH00272 68PH00242 Rear outside seat belt guides (1) are provided on the lateral face of rear seat as shown in the illustration. Periodically inspect the seat belts to make sure they work properly and are not damaged. Check the webbing, buckles, latch plates, retractors, anchorages, and guide loops. Replace any seat belts which do not work properly or are damaged. When the rear seat belt is not fastened, hook the webbing on the belt guide. When the rear seat belt is fastened, unhook the webbing from the belt guide. 2-36 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING WARNING Child Restraint Systems Child restraint EXAMPLE Be sure to inspect all seat belt assemblies after any collision. Any seat belt assembly which was in use during a collision (other than a very minor one) should be replaced, even if damage to the assembly is not obvious. Any seat belt assembly which was not in use during a collision should be replaced if it does not function properly, it is damaged in any way or the seat belt pretensioners were activated (that is, if the front air bags were activated). 60G332S Infant restraint - rear seat only EXAMPLE 80JC007 80JC016 Booster seat EXAMPLE 80JC008 2-37 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING MARUTI SUZUKI highly recommends that you use a child restraint system to restrain infants and small children. Many different types of child restraint systems are available; make sure that the restraint system you select meets applicable safety standards. All child restraint systems are designed to be secured on vehicle seats by seat belts (lap belts or the lap portion of lap-shoulder belts). Whenever possible, MARUTI SUZUKI recommends that child restraint systems be installed on the rear seat. According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in rear seating positions than in front seating positions. If you must use a front-facing child restraint in the front passenger’s seat, adjust the passenger’s seat as far back as possible. NOTE: Observe any statutory regulation about child restraints. WARNING If you install a child restraint system in the rear seat, slide the front seat far enough forward so that the child’s feet do not touch the front seatback. This will help avoid injury to the child in the event of an accident. 58MS030 WARNING Do not install a rear-facing child restraint in the front passenger’s seat. If the passenger’s air bag inflates, a child in a rearfacing child restraint could be killed or seriously injured. The back of a rear-facing child restraint would be too close to the inflating air bag. 2-38 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING WARNING Children could be endangered in a crash if their child restraint systems are not properly secured in the vehicle. When installing a child restraint system, be sure to follow the instructions below. Be sure to secure the child in the restraint system according to the manufacturer’s instructions. Installation with Lap-Shoulder Seat Belts Rear outside seat belt guide (1) 65D608 68PH00271 WARNING If rear outside seat belt is fastened without unhooking the webbing from the belt guide (1), a child restraint system cannot be installed properly in the rear seat. 65D609 2-39 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Installation with a Lap Belt ELR type belt EXAMPLE EXAMPLE Pull to tighten 68PH00243 Install your child restraint system according to the instructions provided by the child restraint system manufacturer. Make sure that the seat belt is securely latched. Try to move the child restraint system in all directions to make sure it is securely installed. 68PH00244 Install your child restraint system according to the instructions provided by the child restraint system manufacturer. To lengthen or tighten the belt, refer to the “Lap-belt” item in this “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” section. After making sure that the seat belt is securely latched, try moving the child restraint system in all directions, to make sure it is securely installed. If you need to tighten the belt, pull the free end of the webbing. 2-40 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Child Restraint System for India Child Restraint The suitability of each passenger’s seat position for carriage of children and fitting of child restraint system is shown in the table below. Whenever you carry children up to 12 years of age, properly use the child restraints which conform to AIS 072, the standard for child restraints, referring to the table. Seating position (or other site) Front Passenger Rear Outboard Rear Centre Intermediate Outboard Intermediate Centre Group 0 Up to 10 kg X U X N.A. N.A. Group 0+ Up to 13 kg X U X N.A. N.A. Group I 9 to 18 kg X U X N.A. N.A. Group II 15 to 25 kg X U X N.A. N.A. Group III 22 to 36 kg X U X N.A. N.A. MASS GROUP Key of letters to be inserted in the above table: U =Suitable for ‘universal’ category restraints approved for use in this mass group X =Seat position not suitable for children in this mass group N.A = Seat position not available for children in this mass group. NOTE: ‘universal’ is the category in the AIS 072. : ‘Outboard’ indicates window side seat. 2-41 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Seat Belt Pretensioner System and/or EXAMPLE Label 68PH00245 WARNING This section of the owner’s manual describes your Vehicle’s SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER SYSTEM. Please read and follow ALL these instructions carefully to minimize your risk of severe injury or death. To determine if your vehicle is equipped with a seat belt pretensioner system at the front seating positions, check the label on the front seat belt at the bottom part. If the letters “p” and/or “PRE” appear as illustrated, your vehicle is equipped with the seat belt pretensioner system. You can use the pretensioner seat belts in the same manner as ordinary seat belts. Read this section and the “Supplemental Restraint System (air bags)” section to learn more about the pretensioner system. The seat belt pretensioner system works with the SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (Air Bags). The crash sensors and the electronic controller of the air bag system also control the seat belt pretensioners. The pretensioners are activated in the event of a frontal crash which is severe enough to trigger the air bags. For precautions and general information including servicing the pretensioner system, refer to the “Supplemental Restraint System (air bags)” section in addition to this “Seat Belt Pretensioner System” section, and follow all those precautions. The pretensioner is located in each front seat belt retractor. The pretensioner tightens the seat belt so the belt fits the occupant’s body more snugly in the event of a frontal crash. The retractors will remain locked after the pretensioners are activated. Upon activation, some noise will occur and some smoke may be released. These conditions are not harmful and do not indicate a fire in the vehicle. The driver and all passengers must be properly restrained by wearing seat belts at all times, whether or not a pretensioner is equipped at their seating position, to minimize the risk of severe injury or death in the event of a crash. Sit fully back in the seat; sit up straight; do not lean forward or sideways. Adjust the belt so the lap portion of the belt is worn low across the pelvis, not across the waist. Please refer to the “Seat Adjustment” section and the instructions and precautions about the seat belts in this “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” section for details on proper seat and seat belt adjustments. Please note that the pretensioners along with the air bags will activate in severe frontal collisions. They are not designed to activate in rear impacts, side impacts, rollovers, or minor frontal collisions. The pretensioners can be activated only once. If the pretensioners are activated (that is, if the air bags are activated), have the pretensioner system serviced by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible. If the “AIR BAG” light on the instrument cluster does not blink or come on briefly when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to 2-42 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING “ON”, stays on for more than 10 seconds, or comes on while driving, the pretensioner system or the air bag system may not work properly. Have both systems inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible. Service on or around the pretensioner system components or wiring must be performed only by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop who is specially trained. Improper service could result in unintended activation of pretensioners or could render the pretensioner inoperative. Either of these two conditions may result in personal injury. To prevent damage or unintended activation of the pretensioners, be sure the battery is disconnected and the ignition switch has been in the “LOCK” position or the ignition mode has been “LOCK” (OFF) for at least 90 seconds before performing any electrical service work on your vehicle. Do not touch pretensioner system components or wiring. The wires are wrapped with yellow tape or yellow tubing, and the couplers are yellow. When scrapping your Vehicle, ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop body repair shop, or scrap yard for assistance. 2-43 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Supplemental Restraint System (air bags) EXAMPLE WARNING This section of the owner’s manual describes the protection provided by your Vehicle’s SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (air bags). Please read and follow ALL these instructions carefully to minimize your risk of severe injury or death in the event of a collision. 2 1 3 5 Your vehicle is equipped with a Supplemental Restraint System consisting of the following components in addition to a lapshoulder belt at each seating position. 1. Driver’s front air bag module 2. Front passenger’s front air bag module 3. Seat belt pretensioners 4. Air bag controller 5. Forward crash sensor 4 3 68PH00246 2-44 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Front Air Bags Air bag symbol meaning WARNING An air bag supplements, or adds to, the crash protection offered by seat belts. The driver and all passengers must be properly restrained by wearing seat belts at all times, whether or not an air bag is mounted at their seating position, to minimize the risk of severe injury or death in the event of a crash. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE “AIR BAG” light 68PH00247 72M00150 You may find this label on the sun visor. WARNING 63J030 If the “AIR BAG” light on the instrument cluster does not blink or come on when the ignition switch is first turned to the “ON” position, or the ignition mode is first changed to “ON”, or the “AIR BAG” light stays on, or comes on while driving, the air bag system (or the seat belt pretensioner system) may not work properly. Have the air bag system inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible. NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint on a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in front of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD can occur. Front air bags are designed to inflate in severe frontal collisions when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position or the ignition mode is “ON”. Front air bags are not designed to inflate in rear impacts, side impacts, rollovers or minor frontal collisions, since they would offer no protection in those types of accidents. Remember, since an air bag deploys only one time during an accident, seat belts are needed to restrain occupants from further movements during the accident. 2-45 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Therefore, an air bag is NOT a substitute for seat belts. To maximize your protection, ALWAYS WEAR YOUR SEAT BELTS. Be aware that no system can prevent all possible injuries that may occur in an accident. Front passenger’s front air bag EXAMPLE Driver’s front air bag EXAMPLE 58MS030 68PH00249 68PH00248 The driver’s front air bag is located behind the center pad of the steering wheel and the front passenger’s front air bag is located behind the passenger’s side of the dashboard. The words “SRS AIRBAG” are molded into the air bag covers to identify the location of the air bags. WARNING Do not install a rear-facing child restraint in the front passenger’s seat. If the passenger’s front air bag inflates, a child in a rear-facing child restraint could be killed or severely injured. The back of a rear-facing child restraint would be too close to the inflating air bag. Please refer to the “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” section in this section for details on securing your child. 2-46 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Conditions of front air bags deployment (inflation) Conditions of front air bags may inflate Receiving a strong impact to the lower body of your vehicle, the front air bags will inflate in many cases. 80J101 • Landing hard or falling 80J097 • In frontal collisions with a fixed wall that does not move or deform in more than about 25 km/h (15 mph) 80J099 • Hitting a curb or medial strip Front air bags may inflate in a strong impact (1) (1) 80J120 80J098E • In collisions such as above at an angle of about 30 degrees (1) or less from the front 80J100E • Falling into a deep hole or ditch • Collision from the rear 2-47 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Front air bags may not inflate The front air bags may not inflate when the impact is absorbed since the collision object moved, vehicle body deformed, or collision angle was greater than about 30 degrees from the front. 80J119 80J104 • Collision from the side • Collision with a utility pole or stumpage 80J102 • Approximately 50 km/h (30 mph) or lower speed frontal collision to a stopped vehicle 80J110 (1) 80J105E • Vehicle rollover • Collision with a fixed wall or guardrail at an angle of greater than about 30 degrees (1) from the front 80J103 • Collision that the front of your vehicle goes under the bed of a truck etc. 2-48 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING How the system works 80J106 • In frontal collisions with a fixed wall that does not move or deform in less than about 25 km/h (15 mph) 80J107 • Collision angle is offset from the vehicle angle (offset collision) In a frontal collision, the crash sensors will detect rapid deceleration, and if the controller judges that the deceleration represents a severe frontal crash, the controller will trigger the inflators. The inflators inflate the air bags with nitrogen or argon gas. The inflated air bags provide a cushion for your head and upper body. The air bag inflates and deflates so quickly that you may not even realize that it has activated. The air bag will neither hinder your view nor make it harder to exit the vehicle. Air bags must inflate quickly and forcefully in order to reduce the chance of serious or fatal injuries. However, an unavoidable consequence of the quick inflation is that the air bag may irritate bare skin, such as the facial area. Also, upon inflation, a loud noise will occur and some powder and smoke will be released. These conditions are not harmful and do not indicate a fire in the vehicle. Be aware, however, that some air bag components may be hot for a while after inflation. in this section for details on proper seat and seat belt adjustments. 65D610 A seat belt helps keep you in the proper position for maximum protection when an air bag inflates. Adjust your seat as far back as possible while still maintaining control of the vehicle. Sit fully back in your seat; sit up straight; do not lean over the steering wheel or dashboard. Please refer to the “Front Seat” section and the “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” section 2-49 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING WARNING • The driver should not lean over the steering wheel. The front passenger should not rest his or her body against the dashboard, or otherwise get too close to the dashboard. In these situations, the outof-position occupant would be too close to an inflating air bag, and may suffer severe injury. • Do not attach any objects to, or place any objects over, the steering wheel or dashboard. Do not place any objects between the air bag and the driver or front passenger. These objects may interfere with air bag operation or may be propelled by the air bag in the event of a crash. Either of these conditions may cause severe injury. Note that even though your vehicle may be moderately damaged in a frontal collision, the collision may not have been severe enough to trigger the air bags to inflate. If your vehicle sustains ANY front-end damage, have the air bag system inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to ensure it is in proper working order. Your vehicle is equipped with a diagnostic module which records information about the air bag system if the air bags deploy in a crash. The module records information about overall system status, which sensors activated the deployment, and for a certain vehicle only, whether the driver’s seat belt was in use. Servicing the air bag system If the air bags inflate, have the air bags and related components replaced by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible. If your vehicle ever gets in deep water and the driver’s floor is submerged, the air bag controller could be damaged. If it does, have the air bag system inspected by the authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible. 90 seconds before performing any electrical service work on your Vehicle. Do not touch air bag system components or wires. The wires are wrapped with yellow tape or yellow tubing, and the couplers are yellow for easy identification. Scrapping a vehicle that has an uninflated air bag can be hazardous. Ask your dealer, body repair shop or scrap yard for help with disposal. Special procedures are required for servicing or replacing an air bag. For that reason, only an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop should be allowed to service or replace your air bags. Please remind anyone who services your vehicle that it has air bags. Service on or around air bag components or wiring must be performed only by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Improper service could result in unintended air bag deployment or could render the air bag inoperative. Either of these two conditions may result in severe injury. To prevent damage or unintended inflation of the air bag system, be sure the battery is disconnected and the ignition switch has been in the “LOCK” position or the ignition mode has been “LOCK” (OFF) for at least 2-50 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Instrument Cluster (Type A) (if equipped) 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Speedometer Fuel gauge Information display Trip meter selector knob Indicator selector knob Warning and indicator lights EXAMPLE 6 4 1 2 6 3 5 68PH02201 2-51 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Speedometer Fuel Gauge NOTE: The activation point of the low fuel warning light (1) varies depending on road conditions (for example, slope or curve) and driving conditions because of fuel moving in the tank. The speedometer indicates vehicle speed. (2) (1) Refer to “Low Fuel Warning Light” in “Warning and Indicator Lights” in this section for details. The mark (2) indicates that the fuel filler door is located on the left side of the vehicle. EXAMPLE 68PH02202 When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, this gauge gives an approximate indication of the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. “F” stands for full and “E” stands for empty. If the fuel meter indicator shows only one segment to “E”, refill the tank as soon as possible. NOTE: If the last segment blinks, it means that the fuel is almost empty. If the low fuel warning light (1) comes on, fill the fuel tank immediately. 2-52 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Brightness Control WARNING Information Display EXAMPLE If you attempt to adjust the display while driving, you could lose control of the vehicle. Do not attempt to adjust the display while driving. (1) EXAMPLE 68PH02203 When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the instrument cluster lights come on. NOTE: • If you do not turn the knob for more than 5 seconds while activating the brightness control, the brightness control display will be canceled automatically. • When you reconnect the battery, the brightness of the instrument panel lights will be reinitialized. Readjust the brightness according to your preference. (1) (2) 68PH02204 Your vehicle has a system to automatically dim the brightness of the instrument panel lights when the position lights or headlights are on. When the position lights and/or headlights are ON, you can control the meter illumination intensity. To increase the brightness of the instrument panel lights, turn the brightness control knob (1) clockwise. To reduce the brightness of the instrument panel lights, turn the brightness control knob (1) counterclockwise. 2-53 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Clock When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the display (A) shows the time. EXAMPLE (A) (B) (D) (C) (3) 68PH02205 (1) Trip meter selector knob (2) Indicator selector knob (3) Information display When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the information display shows the following information. Display (A) Clock Display (B) Fuel gauge Display (C) Trip meter / Odometer / Fuel consumption / Driving range To change the time indication: 1) Push the trip meter selector knob (1) and the indicator selector knob (2) together. 2) To change the hour indication, turn the indicator selector knob (2) left or right repeatedly when the hour indication blinks. To change the hour indication quickly, turn and hold the indicator selector knob (2). To set the hour indication, push the indicator selector knob (2) and the minute indication will blink. 3) To change the minute indication, turn the indicator selector knob (2) left or right repeatedly when the minute indication blinks. To change the minute indication quickly, turn and hold the indicator selector knob (2). To set the minute indication, push the indicator selector knob (2). NOTE: When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the clock indication will be reinitialized. Change the indication again to your preference. Fuel Gauge When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the display (B) shows the fuel gauge. Refer to “Fuel Gauge” in this section. Trip meter / Odometer / Fuel consumption / Driving range When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the display (C) shows one of the following indications, trip meter A, trip meter B, odometer, instantaneous fuel consumption, average fuel consumption or driving range. To switch the display indication (C), push the trip meter selector knob (1) or the indicator selector knob (2) quickly. WARNING If you attempt to adjust the display while driving, you could lose control of the vehicle. Do not attempt to adjust the display while driving. Display (D) Gearshift Indicator 2-54 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) EXAMPLE (a) Trip meter A Trip meter B Odometer Instantaneous fuel consumption Average fuel consumption Driving range WARNING (b) If you attempt to adjust the display while driving, you could lose control of the vehicle. Do not attempt to adjust the display while driving. (c) NOTE: • Indications will change when you push and release a knob. • The display shows estimated values. Indications may not be the same as actual values. (d) (e) Trip meter The trip meter can be used to measure the distance traveled on short trips or between fuel stops. You can use the trip meter A or trip meter B independently. (f) 68PH10201 Push the trip meter selector knob (1). Push the knob (2). indicator selector To reset the trip meter to zero, push and hold the trip meter selector knob (1) for a while when the display shows the trip meter. NOTE: The indicated maximum value of the trip meter is 9999.9. When you run past the maximum value, the indicated value will return to 0.0. Odometer The odometer records the total distance the vehicle has been driven. NOTICE Keep track of your odometer reading and check the maintenance schedule regularly for required services. Increased wear or damage to certain parts can result from failure to perform required services at the proper mileage intervals. Instantaneous fuel consumption The display shows the value of instantaneous fuel consumption only when the vehicle is moving. NOTE: • The display does not show the value unless the vehicle is moving. • For “L/100km” setting, the indicated maximum value of instantaneous fuel consumption is 30. No more than 30 will be indicated on the display even if the actual instantaneous fuel consumption is higher. • For “km/L” setting, the indicated maximum value of instantaneous fuel con- 2-55 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING sumption is 50. No more than 50 will be indicated on the display even if the actual instantaneous fuel consumption is higher. • The indication on the display may be delayed if fuel consumption is greatly affected by driving conditions. • The display shows estimated values. Indications may not be the same as actual values. • You can change the units that instantaneous fuel consumption is displayed in. Refer to “Average fuel consumption” in this section. Average fuel consumption If you selected average fuel consumption the last time you drove the vehicle, the display shows the last value of average fuel consumption from previous driving when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. Unless you reset the value of average fuel consumption, the display indicates the value of average fuel consumption which includes average fuel consumption during previous driving. To reset the average fuel consumption to zero, push and hold the indicator selector knob (2) for a while when the display shows the average fuel consumption. NOTE: When you reset the indication or reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of average fuel consumption will be shown after driving for a while. To change the unit of average fuel consumption, while pushing and holding the trip meter selector knob (1), turn the indicator selector knob (2). “---” for a few seconds and then indicates the current driving range when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. The driving range shown in the display is the approximate distance you can drive until the fuel gauge indicates “E”, based on current driving conditions. When the low fuel warning light comes on, the display “---” will appear. EXAMPLE (Initial setting) If the low fuel warning light comes on, fill the fuel tank immediately regardless of the value of driving range shown in the display. As the driving range after refueling is calculated based on the most recent driving condition, the value is different each time you refuel. 68PH02207 NOTE: • When you change the units that average fuel consumption is displayed in, the instantaneous fuel consumption units will be changed automatically. • When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the unit of the average fuel consumption will be reinitialized. Change the unit again to your preference. NOTE: • If you refuel when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the driving range may not indicate the correct value. • When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of driving range will be shown after driving for a while. Gearshift Indicator Refer to “Gearshift Indicator” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. Driving range If you selected driving range the last time you drove the vehicle, the display indicates 2-56 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Setting mode In the setting mode, you can set up the following functions. Indication Functions Time indication of clock “CL” Central door locking system “d1” Automatic door locking function “d2” Automatic door unlocking function “d3” 2-57 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Indication Functions Additional flashes of the turn signal “L2” Initialization setting “de-on” Exit the setting mode “End” 2-58 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Turn the indicator selector knob (2). Push the knob (2). indicator selector NOTE: Depending on vehicle’s specifications, some items may not be displayed. How to operate the setting mode: 1) When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position and the vehicle is stationary, push the trip meter selector knob (1) to switch the information display indication (C) to the odometer. 2) Push and hold the indicator selector knob (2) until the display shows “CLoCK”. 3) Turn and/or push the indicator selector knob (2) to select a function that you want to set up according to the above chart. 4) Turn and/or push the indicator selector knob (2) to register settings of the following functions. Time indication of clock “CL” • CL-12h: 12-hour format (default setting) • CL-24h: 24-hour format Central door locking system “d1” • d1-SL1: Unlock all doors by turning the key once • d1-SL2: Unlock all doors by turning the key twice (default setting) Automatic door locking function “d2” • d2-SL1: Disable the automatic door locking function • d2-SL2: Lock all doors when the vehicle speed reaches 15 km/h (default setting) Automatic door unlocking function “d3” • d3-SL1: Disable the automatic door unlocking function • d3-SL3: Unlock all doors when the key is pulled out from the ignition switch (default setting) Initialization setting “de-on” • de-on: Initialize all settings EXAMPLE 68PM00272 NOTE: • As shown in the above illustration, “SEL” indicates on the display of currently setting item. • To go back to the higher level display during operation, turn the indicator selector knob (2) to display “bACK” or “-bAC” and then push the indicator selector knob (2). 5) To exit the setting mode, switch the display to show “End” and then push the indicator selector knob (2). Additional flashes of the turn signal “L2” • L2-SL1: Turn signal flashes three times after the turn signal lever is returned (default setting) • L2-SL2: Disable the additional flashes of turn signal 2-59 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Instrument Cluster (Type B) (if equipped) 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Speedometer Tachometer Fuel gauge Temperature gauge Information display Trip meter selector knob Indicator selector knob Warning and indicator lights EXAMPLE 2 6 4 1 8 8 5 8 3 7 68PH02208 2-60 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Speedometer Fuel Gauge Refer to “Low Fuel Warning Light” in “Warning and Indicator Lights” in this section for details. The speedometer indicates vehicle speed. Tachometer The tachometer indicates engine speed in revolutions per minute. The mark (2) indicates that the fuel filler door is located on the left side of the vehicle. (1) NOTICE Never drive the vehicle with the engine revving in the red zone or severe engine damage can result. Keep the engine speed below the red zone even when downshifting to a lower gear position. Refer to “Downshifting maximum allowable speeds” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. (2) EXAMPLE 68PH02209 When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, this gauge gives an approximate indication of the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. “F” stands for full and “E” stands for empty. If the indicator gets off the graduation of “E” (not character “E”), refill the tank as soon as possible. NOTE: The indicator moves a little depending on road conditions (for example, slope or curve) and driving conditions because of fuel moving in the tank. If the low fuel warning light (1) comes on, fill the fuel tank immediately. 2-61 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Temperature Gauge Brightness Control EXAMPLE To reduce the brightness of the instrument panel lights, turn the brightness control knob (1) counterclockwise. WARNING If you attempt to adjust the display while driving, you could lose control of the vehicle. Do not attempt to adjust the display while driving. (1) EXAMPLE 68PH02210 68PH02211 When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, this gauge indicates the engine coolant temperature. Under normal driving conditions, the indicator should stay within the normal, acceptable temperature range between “H” and “C”. If the indicator approaches “H”, overheating is indicated. Follow the instructions for engine overheating in the “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section. When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the instrument cluster lights come on. NOTICE Continuing to drive the vehicle when engine overheating is indicated can result in severe engine damage. Your vehicle has a system to automatically dim the brightness of the instrument panel lights when the position lights or headlights are on. NOTE: • If you do not turn the knob for more than 5 seconds while activating the brightness control, the brightness control display will be canceled automatically. • When you reconnect the battery, the brightness of the instrument panel lights will be reinitialized. Readjust the brightness according to your preference. When the position lights and/or headlights are ON, you can control the meter illumination intensity. To increase the brightness of the instrument panel lights, turn the brightness control knob (1) clockwise. 2-62 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Information Display The information display is shown when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position. The information display shows the following information. EXAMPLE Display (A) Thermometer Display (B) Selector position (for CVT vehicles) / Gearshift indicator (for manual transaxle vehicles) (A) (B) (C) (2) (D) (3) 68PH02213 EXAMPLE Display (C) Trip meter / Odometer / Instantaneous fuel consumption / Average fuel consumption / Driving range Display (D) Clock (2) Trip meter selector knob (3) Indicator selector knob (1) 68PH02212 (1) Information display 2-63 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Thermometer When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the display (A) shows the thermometer. The thermometer indicates the outside temperature. EXAMPLE Selector position (for CVT vehicles) / Gearshift indicator (for manual transaxle vehicles) EXAMPLE (b) b (a) 68PH02215 68PH02214 If the outside temperature nears freezing, the mark (a) will appear on the display. NOTE: • The outside temperature indication is not the actual outside temperature when driving at low speed, or when stopped. • If there is something wrong with the thermometer, or just after the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the display may not indicate the outside temperature. When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the display (B) indicates the gear position (b). For details on how to use the transaxle, refer to “Using the Transaxle” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. Trip meter / Odometer / Instantaneous fuel consumption / Average fuel consumption / Driving range When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the display (C) shows one of the following six indications, trip meter A, trip meter B, odometer, Instantaneous fuel consumption, Average fuel consumption or Driving range. To switch the display indication (C), push the trip meter selector knob (2) or the indicator selector knob (3) quickly. Gearshift indicator Refer to “Gearshift Indicator” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. 2-64 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Push the trip meter selector knob (2). EXAMPLE Push the knob (3). (c) (c) (d) (e) (g) (g) (h) (d) indicator selector Trip meter A Trip meter B Odometer Instantaneous Fuel Consumption Average fuel consumption Driving range WARNING (e) If you attempt to adjust the display while driving, you could lose control of the vehicle. Do not attempt to adjust the display while driving. (f) NOTE: • Indications will change when you push and release a knob. • The display shows estimated values. Indications may not be the same as actual values. (g) (h) Trip meter The trip meter can be used to measure the distance traveled on short trips or between fuel stops. You can use the trip meter A or trip meter B independently. To reset the trip meter to zero, push and hold the trip meter selector knob (2) for a while when the display shows the trip meter. NOTE: The indicated maximum value of the trip meter is 9999.9. When you run past the maximum value, the indicated value will return to 0.0. Odometer The odometer records the total distance the vehicle has been driven. NOTICE Keep track of your odometer reading and check the maintenance schedule regularly for required services. Increased wear or damage to certain parts can result from failure to perform required services at the proper mileage intervals. 68PH10202 2-65 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Instantaneous fuel consumption If you selected instantaneous fuel consumption the last time you drove the vehicle, the display does not show the last value of instantaneous fuel consumption from previous driving when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. The display shows the value only when the vehicle is moving. NOTE: • The display does not show the value unless the vehicle is moving. • For “L/100km” setting, the indicated maximum value of instantaneous fuel consumption is 30. No more than 30 will be indicated on the display even if the actual instantaneous fuel consumption is higher. • For “km/L” setting, the indicated maximum value of value of instantaneous fuel consumption is 50. No more than 50 will be indicated on the display even if the actual instantaneous fuel consumption is higher. • The indication on the display may be delayed if fuel consumption is greatly affected by driving conditions. • The display shows estimated values. Indications may not be the same as actual values. • You can change the units that instantaneous fuel consumption is displayed in. Refer to “Average fuel consumption” in this section. Average fuel consumption If you selected average fuel consumption the last time you drove the vehicle, the display shows the last value of average fuel consumption from previous driving when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. Unless you reset the value of average fuel consumption, the display indicates the value of average fuel consumption which includes average fuel consumption during previous driving. EXAMPLE To reset the average fuel consumption to zero, push and hold the indicator selector knob (3) for a while when the display shows the average fuel consumption. NOTE: When you reset the indication or reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of average fuel consumption will be shown after driving for a while. (For “L/100km” or “km/L” setting) To change the unit of average fuel consumption, while pushing and holding the trip meter selector knob (2), turn the indicator selector knob (3). 68PH02217 NOTE: • When you change the units that average fuel consumption is displayed in, the instantaneous fuel consumption units will be changed automatically. • When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the unit of the average fuel consumption will be reinitialized. Change the unit again to your preference. 2-66 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Driving range If you selected driving range the last time you drove the vehicle, the display indicates “---” for a few seconds and then indicates the current driving range when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. The driving range shown in the display is the approximate distance you can drive until the fuel gauge indicates “E”, based on current driving conditions. When the low fuel warning light comes on, the display “---” will appear. If the low fuel warning light comes on, fill the fuel tank immediately regardless of the value of driving range shown in the display. As the driving range after refueling is calculated based on the most recent driving condition, the value is different each time you refuel. NOTE: • If you refuel when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the driving range may not indicate the correct value. • When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of driving range will be shown after driving for a while. Clock When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the display (D) shows the time. To change the time indication: 1) Push the trip meter selector knob (2) and the indicator selector knob (3) together. 2) To change the hour indication, turn the indicator selector knob (3) left or right repeatedly when the hour indication blinks. To change the hour indication quickly, turn and hold the indicator selector knob (3). To set the hour indication, push the indicator selector knob (3) and the minute indication will flash. 3) To change the minute indication, turn the indicator selector knob (3) left or right repeatedly when the minute indication blinks. To change the minute indication quickly, turn and hold the indicator selector knob (3). To set the minute indication, push the indicator selector knob (3). WARNING If you attempt to adjust the display while driving, you could lose control of the vehicle. Do not attempt to adjust the display while driving. NOTE: When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the clock indication will be reinitialized. Change the indication again to your preference. 2-67 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Setting mode In the setting mode, you can set up the following functions. Indication Functions Central door locking system “ ” Automatic door locking function “ ” Automatic door unlocking function “ Door locking and unlocking siren “ Additional flashes of the turn signal “ ” ” ” 2-68 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Indication Functions Security system “ Shock sensor “ ” ” Pre-warning sensitivity of the shock sensor “ ” Full blast warning sensitivity of the shock sensor “ ” Turn the indicator selector knob (3). Push the knob (3). indicator selector NOTE: Depending on vehicle’s specifications, some items may not be displayed. Initialization setting “ ” Exit the setting mode “ ” How to operate the setting mode: 1) When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position and the vehicle is stationary, push the trip meter selector knob (2) to switch the information display indication (C) to the odometer. 2) Push and hold the indicator selector knob (3) until the display shows “ ”. 3) Turn and/or push the indicator selector knob (3) to select a function that you want to set up according to the above chart. 4) Turn and/or push the indicator selector knob (3) to register settings of the following functions. 2-69 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Central door locking system “ ” • : Unlock all doors by turning the key or pushing the keyless entry system transmitter once • : Unlock all doors by turning the key or pushing the keyless entry system transmitter twice (default setting) Automatic door locking function “ ” • : Disable the automatic door locking function • : Lock all doors when the vehicle speed reaches 15 km/h (default setting) • : (For CVT vehicle) Lock all door when the gearshift lever is in other than “P” Automatic door unlocking function “ ” • : Disable the automatic door unlocking function • : (For CVT vehicle) Unlock all doors when the gearshift lever is moved to the “P” from other position • : Unlock all doors when the key is pulled out from the ignition switch (default setting) Door locking and unlocking siren “ ” • : Siren sounds when the door(s) is(are) locked or unlocked by using the keyless entry system transmitter (default setting) • : Siren does not sound when the door(s) is(are) locked or unlocked by using the keyless entry system transmitter Additional flashes of the turn signal “ ” • : Turn signal flashes three times after the turn signal lever is returned (default setting) • : Disable the additional flashes of turn signal 2-70 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Security system “ ” • : Enable the security system (default setting) • : Disable the security system Shock sensor “ ” • : Enable the shock sensor • : Disable the shock sensor (default setting) Pre-warning sensitivity of the shock sensor “ ” • : Disable the pre-warning • to : Adjust the pre-warning sensitivity of shock sensor (Lowest sensitivity level is L01 and highest is L15, and default setting is L14) Full blast warning sensitivity of the shock sensor “ ” • : Disable the full blast warning • to : Adjust the full blast warning sensitivity of shock sensor (Lowest sensitivity level is L01 and highest is L15, and default setting is L09) 5) to exit the setting mode, switch the display to show “ ” and then push the indicator selector knob (3). EXAMPLE 68PM00272 NOTE: • As shown in the above illustration, “SEL” indicates on the display of currently setting item. • To go back to the higher level display during operation, turn the indicator selector knob (3) to display “ ” or “ ” and then push the indicator selector knob (3). • If the security system “ ” is in the disabled state, the shock sensor “ ”, prewarning sensitivity “ ” and full blast warning sensitivity “ ” cannot be set up. Initialization setting “ ” • : Initialize all settings 2-71 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Instrument Cluster (Type C) (if equipped) 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Speedometer Tachometer Fuel gauge Temperature gauge Information display Trip meter selector knob Indicator selector knob Warning and indicator lights EXAMPLE 2 6 4 1 8 8 5 8 3 7 68PH02222 2-72 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Speedometer Fuel Gauge Refer to “Low fuel warning light” in “Warning and indicator lights” in this section for details. The speedometer indicates vehicle speed. Tachometer The tachometer indicates engine speed in revolutions per minute. The mark (2) indicates that the fuel filler door is located on the left side of the vehicle. (1) NOTICE Never drive the vehicle with the engine revving in the red zone or severe engine damage can result. Keep the engine speed below the red zone even when downshifting to a lower gear position. Refer to “Downshifting maximum allowable speeds” in “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. (2) EXAMPLE 68PH02223 When the ignition mode is “ON”, this gauge gives an approximate indication of the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. “F” stands for full and “E” stands for empty. If the indicator approaches a low level (near “E”) on fuel gauge, refill the tank as soon as possible. NOTE: The indicator moves a little depending on road conditions (for example, slope or curve) and driving conditions because of fuel moving in the tank. If the low fuel warning light (1) comes on, fill the fuel tank immediately. 2-73 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Temperature Gauge Brightness Control WARNING EXAMPLE Do not adjust the brightness of the instrument panel lights while driving. Otherwise, you could lose control of the vehicle. (1) EXAMPLE 68PH02224 68PH02225 When the ignition mode is “ON”, this gauge indicates the engine coolant temperature. Under normal driving conditions, the indicator should stay within the normal, acceptable temperature range between “H” and “C”. If the indicator approaches “H”, overheating is indicated. Follow the instructions for “Engine trouble: Overheating” in “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section. When the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”, the instrument cluster lights come on. NOTICE Continuing to drive the vehicle when engine overheating is indicated can result in severe engine damage. Your vehicle has a system to automatically dim the brightness of the instrument cluster lights when the position lights or headlights are on. You can change the brightness of the instrument cluster lights regardless of whether the position lights or headlights are off or on. NOTE: • If you do not turn the knob for more than 5 seconds while activating the brightness control, the brightness control display will be canceled automatically. • When you reconnect the battery, the brightness of the instrument cluster lights will be reinitialized. Readjust the brightness according to your preference. NOTE: If you select the maximum brightness level when the position lights or headlights are on, the following functions will be cancelled. • The function which automatically dims the brightness of instrument cluster lights • The function which operates with the brightness control, except maximum brightness level To increase the brightness of the instrument cluster lights, turn the indicator selector knob (1) clockwise. To reduce the brightness of the instrument cluster lights, turn the indicator selector knob (1) counterclockwise. 2-74 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Information Display EXAMPLE The information display is shown when the ignition mode is “ON”. (A) Display (D) Gearshift indicator Display (E) Trip meter Display (F) Odometer (B) EXAMPLE (C) (D) (3) (E) ( ) (F) (1) 68PH02226 (1) Information display (2) 68PM00253 (2) Indicator selector knob (3) Trip meter selector knob The information display shows the following information. Display (A) Clock Display (B) Thermometer Display (C) Warning and indicator messages / Fuel consumption / Driving range / Average speed / Driving time / Clock and date / Torque and power 68PH02228 When the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”, the clock display shown in the above illustration will appear on the display for several seconds. Some warning and indicator messages may appear on the display when the ignition mode is “ACC” or “LOCK” (OFF). 2-75 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Clock Thermometer To set the clock, follow “Setting mode” instructions in this section. The thermometer indicates the outside temperature. The display (A) shows the time. The display (B) shows the thermometer. Fuel consumption / Driving range / Average speed / Driving time Clock and date / Torque and power When there are no warning or indicator messages on the display (C), you can select one of the following indications to appear on the display: instantaneous fuel consumption, average fuel consumption, driving range, average speed, driving time, clock and date, torque and power or no indication. WARNING If you attempt to adjust the display while driving, you could lose control of the vehicle. 68PH02229 do not attempt to adjust the display while driving. If the outside temperature nears freezing, the message shown in the above illustration will appear on the display. NOTE: The outside temperature indication is not the actual outside temperature when driving at low speed, or when stopped. 2-76 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING EXAMPLE (a) (b) (c) To switch the display indication, push the indicator selector knob (2) quickly. NOTE: The value of instantaneous fuel consumption, average fuel consumption, driving range, average speed and torque and power shown on the display are affected by the following conditions; • road condition • surrounding traffic condition • driving condition • vehicle condition • a malfunction which causes the malfunction indicator light to come on or blink (f) (e) (d) (a) Instantaneous fuel consumption / Average fuel consumption / Driving range (b) Instantaneous fuel consumption / Average fuel consumption / 5 minute average fuel consumption (c) Average speed / 5 minute average speed / Driving time (d) Clock and date (e) Torque and Power (f) No indication 2-77 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Instantaneous fuel consumption The display shows instantaneous fuel consumption with a bar graph only when the vehicle is moving. EXAMPLE • (4) • • • 68PM00280 (4) Instantaneous fuel consumption NOTE: • The display does not show the bar graph unless the vehicle is moving. • For “L/100km” setting, the indicated maximum value of instantaneous fuel consumption is 30. No more than 30 will be indicated on the display even if the actual instantaneous fuel consumption is higher. • For “km/L” setting, the indicated maximum value of value of instantaneous fuel consumption is 50. No more than 50 will be indicated on the display even if the actual instantaneous fuel consumption is higher. For “MPG(UK)” setting, the indicated maximum value of instantaneous fuel consumption is 80. No more than 80 will be indicated on the display even if the actual instantaneous fuel consumption is higher. For “MPG(US)” setting, the indicated maximum value of instantaneous fuel consumption is 60. No more than 60 will be indicated on the display even if the actual instantaneous fuel consumption is higher. The indication on the display may be delayed if fuel consumption is greatly affected by driving conditions. The display shows estimated values. Indications may not be the same as actual values. Average fuel consumption / 5-minute average fuel consumption Average fuel consumption from previous reset and 5-minute average fuel consumption are shown. (Average fuel consumption) EXAMPLE (5) (5) 68PM00281 (5) Average fuel consumption If you selected average fuel consumption the last time you drove the vehicle, the display shows the last value of average fuel consumption from previous driving when the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”. Unless you reset the value of average fuel consumption, the display indicates the value of average fuel consumption based on the average fuel consumption during previous driving. NOTE: When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of average fuel consumption will be shown after driving for a period of time. 2-78 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING You can select when the value of average fuel consumption is reset from among the following two methods; • Reset after refuel: the value of average fuel consumption will be reset automatically by refueling. • Reset with trip meter A: the value of average fuel consumption will be reset automatically by resetting trip meter A. To change when the value of average fuel consumption is reset, refer to “Setting mode” in this section. NOTE: • If you add only a small amount of fuel when you select “Reset after refuel”, the average fuel consumption value may not be reset. • Display option (b) shows the fuel consumption history below current instantaneous fuel consumption. History display portion is updated to show fuel consumption history every 5 minutes (till past 15 minutes) or every driving cycle (till past 3 driving cycle) depending on which mode is selected in setting mode. (5-minute average fuel consumption) Driving range EXAMPLE EXAMPLE (6) (7) 68PM00282 (6) 5-minute average fuel consumption You can check transition of 5-minute average fuel consumption every 5 minutes from 15 minutes before up to now. Time indication and driving cycle indication can be changed. For details, refer to “Setting mode” in this section. 68PM00283 (7) Driving range If you selected driving range the last time you drove the vehicle, the display indicates “---” for a few seconds and then indicates the current driving range when engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”. The driving range shown in the display is the approximate distance you can drive until the fuel gauge indicates “E”, based on current driving conditions. When the low fuel warning light comes on, the display “---” will appear. If the low fuel warning light comes on, fill the fuel tank immediately regardless of the value of driving range shown in the display. As the driving range after refueling is calculated based on the most recent driving 2-79 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING condition, the value is different each time you refuel. NOTE: • If you refuel when the ignition mode is “ON”, the driving range may not indicate the correct value. • When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of driving range will be shown after driving for a period of time. Average Speed / 5- minute average speed Average speed from previous reset and 5minute average speed are shown. (Average Speed) EXAMPLE (8) If you selected average speed the last time you drove the vehicle, the display indicates the last value of average speed from previous driving when the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”. Unless you reset the value of average speed, the display indicates the value of average speed which includes average speed during previous driving. (5-minute average speed) EXAMPLE (9) To reset the value of average speed, push and hold the indicator selector knob (2) for about 2 seconds when the display indicates an average speed. The display shows “---” and then indicates a new average speed after driving for a short time. NOTE: • When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of average speed will be shown after driving for a period of time. • Display (c) shows current average speed and average speed history. History display portion is below current average speed and is updated every 5 minutes (till past 10 minutes). 68PM00285 (9) 5-minute average speed You can check transition of 5-minute average speed every 5 minutes from 10 minutes before up to now. 68PM00284 (8) Average speed 2-80 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Driving time EXAMPLE Torque and Power Present engine torque and power are shown. Gearshift Indicator Information of after driving When you press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF), the following information appears for several seconds on the information display. Refer to “Gearshift Indicator” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. EXAMPLE (10) NOTE: Disconnection of the battery negative (-) terminal will reset the indication of the driving time. Clock and date Date and time are shown. For the setting procedure, refer to “Setting mode” in this section. Trip meter The display (E) shows the trip meter. The trip meter can be used to measure the distance traveled on short trips or between fuel stops. You can use trip meter A or trip meter B independently. To reset the trip meter to zero, push and hold the trip meter selector knob (3) for about 2 seconds when the display shows the trip meter. 68PM00286 (10) Driving time Driving time from previous reset is shown. To reset the driving time, push and hold the indicator selector knob (2) for about 2 seconds when the display indicates a driving time. The display shows “---” and then indicates a new driving time after driving for a short time. The display (D) shows some of the following indications. Odometer The display (F) shows the odometer. 68PS00214 Torque and Power display Display (e) shows Torque and Power graphs at various vehicle condition. This figure is for reference only and indication may not be same as actual value. The odometer records the total distance the vehicle has been driven. NOTICE Keep track of your odometer reading and check the maintenance schedule regularly for required services. Increased wear or damage to certain parts can result from failure to perform required services at the proper mileage intervals. 2-81 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Setting mode When the ignition mode is “ON” and the vehicle is stationary, you can enter the setting mode of the information display by pushing and holding the indicator selector knob (2) for more than 3 seconds. • To select the setting that you want to change, turn the indicator selector knob (2) left or right. • To change the setting, push the indicator selector knob (2). • To exit the setting mode, select “Back” and push the indicator selector knob (2). EXAMPLE NOTE: • If you push and hold the indicator selector knob (2) to enter the setting mode when the display (C) shows average fuel consumption or average speed, the value will be reset simultaneously. If you do not want to reset the value, push the indicator selector knob quickly to switch the indication of the display. • If you turn the ignition switch, press the engine switch or start to move the vehicle when the display is in the setting mode, the setting mode will be canceled automatically. Distance unit (Odometer / trip meter distance unit setting) You can change the units in which odometer / trip meter distance is displayed. NOTE: When you change the units in which odometer / trip meter distance is displayed, the trip meter will be reset automatically. 68PH02231 NOTE: The currently selected setting item is surrounded by a frame. Fuel reset (Average fuel consumption reset setting) You can change when the value of average fuel consumption is reset. Temperature (Temperature unit setting) You can change the units that temperature is displayed in. NOTE: When you change the units that temperature is displayed in, the automatic heating and air conditioning system (if equipped) temperature display units will be changed automatically. Set sensors (Parking sensor setting) (if equipped) The parking sensor can be switched between the normal mode and trailer mode. Fuel economy (Fuel consumption unit setting) You can change the units that fuel consumption is displayed in. Language You can change the language of the information display. 2-82 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Clock setting (Adjusting the clock) • To change the hour indication, turn the indicator selector knob (2) left or right repeatedly when the hour indication appears as reversed color. To change the hour indication quickly, turn and hold the indicator selector knob (2). To set the hour indication, push the indicator selector knob (2) and the minute indication appears as reversed color. • To change the minute indication, turn the indicator selector knob (2) left or right repeatedly when the minute indication appears as reversed color. To change the minute indication quickly, turn and hold the indicator selector knob (2). To set the minute indication, push the indicator selector knob (2). You can also switch the time indication between 12-hour and 24-hour format. (Adjusting the date) Adjust year, month, and day by operating the indicator selector knob (2) in the same way as the adjusting the clock. Door lock (Door lock setting) You can choose either once or twice operation(s) to unlock all doors (including the tailgate) by turning the key, or operating keyless push start system remote controller or request switch. You can also turn off or on the buzzer sound when the door(s) is(are) locked or unlocked. (Shock sensor system setting) You can change the on/off of the shock sensor. Lights (Light setting) (Footwell light setting) (if equipped) The footwell lights can be programmed for interlocked operation with either lighting control or door operation and for no lighting. (Shock sensor P setting) You can adjust the pre-warning sensitivity of shock sensor. (Lane Change setting) The turn signal and its indicator can be set whether they flash three times even if you return the turn signal control lever immediately after moving it. Display item (car color setting) You can change the car color of the information display. Guide me light setting (Light Setting) (if equipped) You can change the lighting time of “To car” function or “To home” function. Antitheft (Theft deterrent alarm system setting) (if equipped) You can switch the theft deterrent alarm system from the enabled state to the disabled state, and vice versa. The state of the theft deterrent alarm system is shown on the information display as follows: • Mode A: Disabled state • Mode D: Enabled state (Shock sensor F setting) You can adjust the full blast warning sensitivity of shock sensor. (Calendar dis setting) You can change the on/off of the calendar. (Calendar form setting) You can change the calendar form of the information display. Fuel eco history (Fuel Economy History Setting) Transitional indication of average fuel consumption can be switched to timed indication and driving cycle indication. 2-83 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Default (initialization setting) If you select “YES” and push the indicator selector knob (2), all settings will be reinitialized. Trip Summary display Trip Summary display comes when ignition mode is switched to ‘OFF” position. Following summary is displayed. • Driving Time : Time from ignition “ON” condition to ignition “OFF” condition is displayed. • Driving Mileage : Distance covered from ignition “OFF” condition is displayed. Warning and Indicator Messages The display shows warning and indicator messages to let you know about certain vehicle problems. A tone may also sound to alert you. NOTE: • When the problem that causes a message to appear is corrected, the message will disappear. • If a message is displayed, and other problems requiring a message occur, the message for each of the problems will be alternately displayed about every 5 seconds. • When you push and hold the indicator selector knob (2) for about 2 seconds while a message is displayed, the message will disappear temporarily. If the problem that caused the message is not corrected, the message will appear again after 5 seconds. If warning and indicator messages appear on the display, follow the messages. Master warning indicator light 78K049 When the display shows warning and indicator messages, the master warning indicator light may also blink. 2-84 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and indicator messages All model Warning and indicator message Master warning indicator light Sound Cause and remedy Blinks (only while vehicle is in motion) Beep (one time from interior buzzer; only while vehicle is in motion) A door or tailgate is not properly closed. Stop the vehicle in a safe place and close the door or tailgate properly. (#1) Blinks Continuous beep (from interior buzzer) The headlights and/or the position lights are left on. Turn them off. 68PH02232 68PH02233 (#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected. 2-85 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and indicator message Master warning indicator light Sound Cause and remedy Off Beep (one time from interior buzzer) Fuel is low. Refill it immediately. (#1) Off Off The road may be icy. Drive very carefully. (#1) 68PH02234 68PH02235 (#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected. 2-86 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and indicator message Master warning indicator light Sound Cause and remedy Off Off This message is displayed when “ACC” position is selected as the power supply position. (#1) Off Off The clutch pedal is depressed. Press the engine switch to start the engine. 68PH02237 68PH02238 (#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected. 2-87 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and indicator message Master warning indicator light Blinks Sound Cause and remedy Beep (one time from interior buzzer) If this message is displayed, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized Maruti Suzuki workshop. 68PH02236 2-88 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and indicator message Master warning indicator light Sound Cause and remedy Blinks Beep (one time from interior buzzer) There is a problem with the steering lock system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized Maruti Suzuki workshop. Blinks Beep (one time from interior buzzer) There is a problem with the keyless push start system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized Maruti Suzuki workshop. 68PH02239 68PH02240 2-89 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and indicator message Master warning indicator light Blinks Sound Cause and remedy Series of beeps under certain conditions (for about 2 seconds from exterior and/or interior buzzers) The remote controller may be outside the vehicle or its battery may have become discharged. Locate the remote controller or touch the engine switch with the remote controller. If the message still appears, replace the remote controller battery. 68PH02241 68PH02242 2-90 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and indicator message Master warning indicator light Sound Cause and remedy Off Off This message is displayed when “ON” position is selected as the power supply position. (#1) Blinks Beep (one time from interior buzzer) The steering lock is not disengaged. While lightly turning the steering wheel in both directions, press the engine switch again. 68PH02243 68PH02244 (#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected. 2-91 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and indicator message Master warning indicator light Sound Cause and remedy Off Off The remote controller battery is about to become flat. Replace the battery. (#1) Off Off The engine switch is pressed without depressing the brake and clutch pedals. Try again as instructed by the message. 68PH02245 68PH02246 (#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected. 2-92 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Diesel engine model Warning and indicator message Master warning indicator light Sound Cause and remedy Blinks Beep (one time from interior buzzer) There may be a problem with the fuel filter. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized Maruti Suzuki workshop. Blinks Beep (one time from interior buzzer) It is possible that water may be in the fuel filter. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized Maruti Suzuki workshop. 68PH02247 68PH02248 2-93 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and indicator message Master warning indicator light Off Sound Off Cause and remedy If the coolant temperature is cool enough, this message is displayed when the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON” and this message will disappear when the glow plug is heated enough for engine starting. 68PH02249 • If your vehicle is equipped with a parking sensor system, the information display also indicates warning and indicator messages related to the system. For information on these messages, refer to “Parking sensors (if equipped)” in “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. 2-94 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and Indicator Lights NOTE: if warning and indicator lights blink or come on, the corresponding messages may be shown on the information display. Brake System Warning Light The light should go out after starting the engine and fully releasing the parking brake, if the fluid level in the brake fluid reservoir is adequate. The light also comes on together with the ABS warning light when the rear brake force control function (proportioning valve function) of the ABS system fails. If the brake system warning light comes on while you are driving the vehicle, it may mean that there is something wrong with the vehicle’s brake system. If this happens, you should: 65D477 Three different types of operations exist depending on the vehicle’s specification. 1) The light comes on briefly when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”. 2) The light comes on when the parking brake is engaged with the ignition switch in the “ON” position or the ignition mode “ON”. 3) The light comes on when under either or both of above two conditions. The light also comes on when the fluid in the brake fluid reservoir falls below the specified level. 1) Pull off the road and stop carefully. WARNING Remember that stopping distance may be longer, you may have to push harder on the pedal, and the pedal may go down farther than normal. 2) Test the brakes by carefully starting and stopping on the shoulder of the road. 3) If you determine that it is safe, drive cautiously at low speed to the nearest dealer for repairs, or 4) Have the vehicle towed to the nearest dealer for repairs. WARNING If any of the following conditions occur, you should immediately ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to inspect the brake system. • If the brake system warning light does not go out after the engine has been started and the parking brake has been fully released. • If the brake system warning light does not come on when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”. • If the brake system warning light comes on at any time during vehicle operation. NOTE: Because the brake system is self-adjusting, the fluid level will drop as the brake pads become worn. Replenishing the brake fluid reservoir is considered normal periodic maintenance. NOTE: (Parking Brake Reminder Buzzer) A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind you to release the parking brake if you start the vehicle without releasing the parking brake. Make sure that the parking brake is fully released and the brake system warning light turns off. 2-95 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light If the light and the brake system warning light stay on, or come on simultaneously when driving, your ABS system is equipped with the rear brake force control function (proportioning valve function) and there may be something wrong with both the rear brake force control function and anti-lock function of the ABS system. 65D529 When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”, the light comes on briefly so you can check that the light is working. If the light stays on, or comes on when driving, there may be something wrong with the ABS. If this happens: 1) Pull off the road and stop carefully. 2) Turn the ignition switch to “LOCK” or change the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF) by pressing the engine switch and then start the engine again. If the warning light comes on briefly then turns off, the system is normal. If the warning light still stays on, the system will be something wrong. If one of these happens, have the system inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. If the ABS becomes inoperative, the brake system will function as an ordinary brake system that does not have this ABS system. For details of ABS system, refer to “AntiLock Brake System (ABS)” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. Oil Pressure Light 50G051 This light comes on when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”, and goes out when the engine is started. The light will come on and remain on if there is insufficient oil pressure. If the light comes on when driving, pull off the road as soon as you can and stop the engine. Check the oil level and add oil if necessary. If there is enough oil, the lubrication system should be inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop before you drive the vehicle again. NOTICE • If you operate the engine with this light on, severe engine damage can result. • Do not rely on the oil pressure light to indicate the need to add oil. Be sure to periodically check the engine oil level. 2-96 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Charging Light The light will come on and remain on if there is something wrong with the battery charging system. If the light comes on when the engine is running, the charging system should be inspected immediately by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Driver’s Seat Belt Reminder Light 50G052 60G049 This light comes on when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”, and goes out when the engine is started. When the driver doesn’t buckle his or her seat belt, this light will come on and/or blink. For details about the seat belt reminder, refer to “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” in this section. 2-97 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING “AIR BAG” Light Malfunction Indicator Light 63J030 This light blinks or comes on for several seconds when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON” so you can check if the light is working. The light will come on and stay on if there is a problem in the air bag system or the seat belt pretensioner system. WARNING If the “AIR BAG” light does not blink or come on briefly when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”, stays on for more than 10 seconds, or comes on while driving, the air bag system or the seat belt pretensioner system may not work properly. Have both systems inspected by an authorized Maruti Suzuki workshop. Transaxle Warning Light (if equipped) 65D530 Your vehicle has a computer-controlled emission control system. A malfunction indicator light is provided on the instrument panel to indicate when it is necessary to have the emission control system serviced. The malfunction indicator light comes on when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON” to let you know the light is working and goes out when the engine is started. If the malfunction indicator light comes on or blinks when the engine is running, there is a damage in the emission control system. Bring the vehicle to your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to have the damage fixed. 80J219 This light comes on for several seconds when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON” so you can check the light is working. If this light comes on when the engine is running, there is a problem with the transaxle system. Ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to have the system inspected. NOTE: If the CVT fluid temperature becomes too high, this light will blink. Stop the vehicle in a safe place and let the fluid cool down. NOTICE Continuing to drive the vehicle when the malfunction indicator light is on or blinking can cause permanent damage to the vehicle’s emission control system, and can affect fuel economy and driveability. 2-98 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Immobilizer/Keyless Push Start System Warning Light Low Fuel Warning Light 80JM122 When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”, the light comes on briefly so you can check that the light is working. If this light stays on, there is a problem with the system. Open Door Warning Light Electric Power Steering Light 54G343 79J039 If this light comes on, fill the fuel tank immediately. This light comes on when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”, and goes out when the engine is started. When this light comes on, a ding sounds once to remind you to fill the fuel. If you do not fill the fuel, a ding sounds every time when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”. NOTE: The activation point of this light varies depending on road conditions (for example, slope or curve) and driving conditions because of fuel moving in the tank. 54G391 This light remains on until all doors are completely closed. If any door is open when the vehicle is moving, a ding sounds to remind you to close all doors completely. If this light comes on while driving, the power steering system may not work properly. Have the system inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. NOTE: Following operations of the steering wheel while parking or driving at a very lowspeed may have steering effort bigger gradually. This is not a malfunction of the steering system, but the power steering control system limits the power assist in order to prevent them from overheating. • The steering wheel is operated very often. • The steering wheel is kept in a fully turned position for a long while. When the power steering control system cool down, the power steering system back to the original condition. 2-99 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING However, repeating these operations could cause the power steering system damaged. If this light blinks, there is a problem with the system. Have your vehicle inspected by your MARUTI SUZUKI dealer. NOTE: If the power steering system does not work properly, you will feel heavier to steer but you still will be able to steer. High engine coolant temperature warning light (red color) NOTE: If the steering is operated, you may hear noise. This is normal and indicates that the power steering system works properly. Engine coolant temperature light (if equipped) arrows will flash along with all of the turn signal lights. Main Beam (high beam) Indicator Light If this light blinks while driving, it means the engine is running hot. Avoid driving conditions that may lead to actual overheating. If the light stays on without blinking, then the engine is overheating. Follow the instructions in the “Engine trouble: Overheating” of “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section. 50G056 This indicator comes on when headlight main beams (high beams) are turned on. NOTICE Continuing to drive the vehicle when engine overheating is indicated can result in severe engine damage. Illumination Indicator Light Turn Signal Indicators 68PH00274 When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, this light comes on briefly so you can check that the light is working. This indicator has two following functions. Low engine coolant temperature light (blue color) This light stays on while the engine is still cold and goes off when the engine has warmed up. 64J045 50G055 This indicator light comes on while the position lights, tail light and/or the headlights are on. When you turn on the left or right turn signals, the corresponding green arrow on the instrument panel will flash along with the respective turn signal lights. When you turn on the hazard warning switch, both 2-100 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Front Fog Light Indicator Light (if equipped) Fuel Filter Warning Light (if equipped) Master Warning Indicator Light (if equipped) 68PH00273 60A541 78K049 The front fog light indicator light comes on when the front fog light operates. This light comes on for several seconds when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON” so you can check that light is working. If the light comes on when driving, there is a possibility to have water in the fuel filter. Drain water as soon as possible. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. When the information display shows warning and indicator messages, this indicator light may also blink. Glow Plug Indicator Light (if equipped) For details, refer to “Information display” in this section. 60A543 If the coolant temperature is cool enough, this light comes on when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON” and goes out when the glow plug is heated enough for engine starting. 2-101 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Lighting Control Lever Lighting Operation EXAMPLE EXAMPLE (3) (2) (1) 68PH00251 65D611 WARNING To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the steering wheel. 68PH00250 To turn the lights on or off, twist the knob on the end of the lever. There are three positions: OFF (1) All lights are off. (2) Front position lights, tail lights, license plate light and instrument lights are on, but headlights are off. With the headlights on, push the lever forward to switch to the high beams (main beams) or pull the lever toward you to switch to the low beams. When the high beams (main beams) are on, a light on the instrument panel will come on. To momentarily activate the high beams (main beams) as a passing signal, pull the lever slightly toward you and release it when you have completed the signal. (3) Front position lights, tail lights, license plate light, instrument lights and headlights are on. 2-102 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Automatic Lights Operation (if equipped) Your vehicle’s lighting system is controlled by two main systems: the Lighting switch and the Auto-On Headlight System (when the lighting switch is in the “AUTO” position). The two systems work together to operate your lights as shown in the following chart: EXAMPLE (3) (2) (4) (1) 68PH00252 (5) 68PH00253 2-103 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING ON: Lights ON LIGHT: When it is light around the light sensor (5). DARK: When it is dark around the light sensor (5). Lighting switch position (1) OFF (2) AUTO (3) (4) Main lights to be operated Position lights, Tail lights Headlights Position lights, Tail lights Headlights Position lights, Tail lights Headlights Position lights, Tail lights Headlights To turn the lights on or off, twist the knob on the end of the lever. There are four positions: Ignition mode “LOCK” (OFF) or “ACC” LIGHT DARK Ignition mode “ON” LIGHT DARK – – – – – – – – – – – ON – – – ON ON ON ON ON – – – – ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON OFF (1) All lights are off. AUTO (2) This function works when the ignition mode has been changed to “ON” by pressing the engine switch. The headlights and position lights are turned on and off automatically according to the amount of outside light detected by a sensor. They go out automatically when you change the ignition mode to “ACC” or “LOCK” by pressing the engine switch. The light sensor (5) for sensing the amount of outside light is installed on the passenger’s seat side instrument panel. CAUTION If the light sensor area of the windshield is covered with mud, ice, or other similar substances, the headlights and position lights may be turned on even when it is still light outside. 2-104 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING NOTE: • Avoid covering the light sensor area of the windshield with a sticker. The sticker may impair the performance of the sensor and make the system unable to control operation of the lights correctly. • If you changed the ignition mode to “ON” by pressing the engine switch and the “AUTO” position remains selected, the headlights and position lights come on automatically as the outside gets dark even with the engine not running. Leaving the lights lit for a long time may lead to a completely discharged battery. Auto-on headlight system EXAMPLE (5) 68PH00254 (3) Front position lights, tail lights, license plate light and instrument lights are on, but headlights are off. (4) Front position lights, tail lights, license plate light, instrument lights and headlights are on. With the headlights on, push the lever forward to switch to the high beams (main beams) or pull the lever toward you to switch to the low beams. When the high beams (main beams) are on, a light on the instrument panel will come on. To momentarily activate the high beams (main beams) as a passing signal, pull the lever slightly toward you and release it when you have completed the signal. 68PH00253 The Auto-on headlight system automatically turns on all lights that are operated by the lighting control lever on the steering column, when the following three conditions are all met. Conditions for Auto-on headlight system operation: 1) It is dark around the light sensor (5). 2) The lighting control lever is in the “AUTO” position. 3) You press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “ON”. This system is operated by a signal from the light sensor (5) on the passenger’s seat side Instrument panel. Do not cover the sensor (5). If you do, the system will not work correctly. 2-105 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING WARNING It takes about 5 seconds for the light sensor to react to a change in lighting conditions. To help avoid an accident due to reduced visibility, turn on your headlights before driving into a tunnel, parking structure or the like. NOTE: The light sensor reacts even to infrared rays, so it may operate incorrectly when there are strong infrared rays. Light Reminder Buzzer The interior buzzer continuously beeps if you open the driver’s door without turning off the headlights and position lights. This function is triggered under the following condition: The headlights and/or position lights are on even after the ignition switch is turned off, or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF). The buzzer stops sounding when you turn off the headlights and position lights. Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.) System (if equipped) When the engine is started, this system turns on the daytime running lights. Conditions for D.R.L. system operation 1) The engine is running. 2) Headlights and front fog light (if equipped) are off. NOTE: Brightness of the daytime running lights is different from the brightness of the position lights, but it is not a malfunction. NOTE: A message is indicated on the information display in the instrument cluster while the buzzer is sounding. 2-106 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Guide Me Light (Vehicle with Automatic Lights Operation) Follow me home function This function turns on the front position lights and the headlights in the low beam setting for about 10, 15, 20, 25 or 30 seconds after the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF). To set the function: 1) Turn the lighting switch to the “AUTO” position 2) Press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF). 3) Pull the lighting control lever toward you once and open the driver’s side door within 60 seconds. Or pull the lighting control lever toward you once while the driver’s side door is open. To cancel the function: Perform any of the following operations. • Pull the lighting control lever toward you once. • Change the ignition mode to “ACC” or “ON” by pressing the engine switch. • Turn the lighting switch to any other position than the “AUTO” position. NOTE: • When the “follow me home” is functioning, the front fog lights and the headlights (high beam) are not turned on. • Lighting time of the “follow me home function” can be changed on the infor- mation display. Refer to “Information Display” in this section. Lead to vehicle function If the “UNLOCK” button of the remote controller is pressed while the lighting switch is positioned in the “AUTO”, the front position lights and the headlights in the low beam are turned on for 10, 15, 20, 25 or 30 seconds. The lead to vehicle function will operate only when it is dark outside the vehicle. To cancel the function: Perform any of the following operations. • Lock the doors by using the remote controller or request switch, or the key in the driver’s door lock. • Change the ignition mode to “ACC” or “ON” by pressing the engine switch. • Turn the lighting switch to any other position than the “AUTO” position. NOTE: • When the “lead to vehicle” is functioning, the front fog lights and the headlights (high beam) are not turned on. • Lighting time of the “lead to vehicle function” can be changed on the information display. Refer to “Information Display” in this section. Front Fog Light Switch (if equipped) EXAMPLE 68PH00256 To turn the front fog light on, twist the knob as shown in the illustration with the position lights, tail lights and/or the headlights are on. When the front fog light is on, an indicator light on the instrument cluster will come on. NOTE: In some countries the lighting operation may be different from the above description according to local regulations. 2-107 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Headlight Leveling Switch Vehicle with the halogen headlights Vehicle Load Condition EXAMPLE 68PH00257 Level the headlight beam according to the load condition of your vehicle by turning this switch. The chart below shows the appropriate switch position for different vehicle-load conditions. Turn Signal Control Lever Switch Position Driver only 0 Driver + 1 passenger (in front seat) 0 Driver + 4 passengers, no cargo 1 Driver + 4 passengers, cargo added 2 Driver + full cargo 3 65D611 Vehicle with the discharge headlights Vehicle Load Condition Switch Position Driver only 0 Driver + 1 passenger (in front seat) 0 Driver + 4 passengers, no cargo 1 Driver + 4 passengers, cargo added 2 Driver + full cargo 3 WARNING To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the steering wheel. Turn Signal Operation With the ignition switch in the “ON” position or the ignition mode “ON”, move the lever up or down to activate the right or left turn signals. 2-108 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Normal turn signal Sometimes, such as when changing lanes, the steering wheel is not turned far enough to cancel the turn signal. For convenience, you can flash the turn signal by moving the lever part way and holding it there. The lever will return to its normal position when you release it. Hazard Warning Switch EXAMPLE NOTE: The turn signal and its indicator flash three times even if you return the lever immediately after moving it. EXAMPLE 68PH00258 Move the lever all the way upward or downward to signal. When the turn is completed, the signal will cancel and the lever will return to its normal position. NOTE: The turn signal and its indicator can be set whether they flash three times after the turn signal lever is returned via the information display. Refer to “Information Display” in this section. NOTE: You can customize the setting for the number of times of flashing of the turn signal and its indicator. Please ask an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for the customization. Lane change signal 79MH0231 Push in the hazard warning switch to activate the hazard warning lights. All turn signal lights and both turn signal indicators will flash simultaneously. To turn off the lights, push the switch again. Use the hazard warning lights to warn other traffic during emergency parking or when your vehicle could otherwise become a traffic hazard. EXAMPLE 68PH00259 2-109 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever Windshield Wipers Windshield Washer EXAMPLE 65B611 WARNING To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the steering wheel. Wiper and Washer Operation When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position or the ignition mode is “ON”, you can use the wiper/washer lever. EXAMPLE 68PH00261 68PH00262 To turn the windshield wipers on, move the lever down to one of the three operating positions. In the “INT” position, the wipers operate intermittently. The “INT” position is very convenient for driving in mist or light rain. In the “LO” position, the wipers operate at a steady low speed. In the “HI” position, the wipers operate at a steady high speed. To turn off the wipers, move the lever back to the “OFF” position. Move the lever up and hold it to the “MIST” position, the windshield wipers will turn on continuously at low speed. To spray windshield washer fluid, pull the lever toward you. The windshield wipers will automatically turn on at low speed if they are not already on and the “INT” position is equipped. WARNING • To prevent windshield icing in cold weather, turn on the defroster to heat the windshield before and during windshield washer use. • Do not use radiator antifreeze in the windshield washer reservoir. It can severely impair visibility when sprayed on the windshield, and can also damage your vehicle’s paint. 2-110 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING NOTICE To help prevent damage to the windshield wiper and washer system components, you should take the following precautions: • Do not continue to hold in the lever when there is no windshield washer fluid being sprayed or the washer motor can be damaged. • Do not attempt to remove dirt from a dry windshield with the wipers or you can damage the windshield and the wiper blades. Always wet the windshield with washer fluid before operating the wipers. • Clear ice or packed snow from the wiper blades before using the wipers. • Check the washer fluid level regularly. Check it often when the weather is bad. • Only fill the washer fluid reservoir 3/4 full during cold weather to allow room for expansion if the temperature falls low enough to freeze the solution. Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch (if equipped) NOTICE Clear ice or snow from the rear window and rear wiper blade before using the rear wiper. Accumulated ice or snow could prevent the wiper blade from moving, causing damage to the wiper motor. EXAMPLE Washer Wiper 68PH00263 To turn the rear wiper on, twist the rear wiper switch on the end of the lever forward to the “ON” position. To turn the rear wiper off, twist the switch rearward to the “OFF” position. With the rear wiper in the “OFF” position, twist the switch rearward and hold it there to spray window washer fluid. With the rear wiper in the “ON” position, turn the switch forward and hold it there to spray window washer fluid. 2-111 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Tilt/Telescoping (if equipped) Steering Lock Lever EXAMPLE WARNING Never attempt to adjust the steering wheel while the vehicle is moving or you could lose control of the vehicle. Horn EXAMPLE (1) (2) 68PH00264 (1) LOCK (2) UNLOCK The lock lever is located under the steering column. To adjust the steering wheel height and fore-aft position: 68PH00265 Press the horn button of the steering wheel to sound the horn. The horn will sound with the ignition switch in any position or any ignition mode. 1) Push down the lock lever to unlock the steering column. 2) Adjust the steering wheel to the desired height and fore-aft position and lock the steering column by pulling the lock lever. 3) Try moving the steering wheel up and down and back and forth to make sure it is securely locked in position. 2-112 68PH0-74E BEFORE DRIVING Heated Rear Window Switch (If equipped) (1) NOTE: • The defogger will work only when the engine is running. The defogger will automatically turn off after the defogger remains on for 15 minutes to prevent discharging of the battery. EXAMPLE 68PH00266 When the rear window is misted, push this switch (1) to clear the window. An indicator light will be lit when the defogger is on. The defogger will work only when the engine is running. To turn off the defogger, push the switch again. NOTICE The heated rear window uses a large amount of electricity. Be sure to turn off after the window has become clear. 2-113 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE 60G408 Exhaust Gas Warning ......................................................... 3-1 Daily Inspection Checklist .................................................. 3-1 Engine Oil Consumption .................................................... 3-2 3 Ignition Switch (Vehicle without Keyless Push Start System) .................. 3-3 Engine Switch (Vehicle with Keyless Push Start System) ........................ 3-5 Keyless Push Start System (if equipped) ......................... 3-6 Parking Brake Lever ........................................................... 3-9 Pedal ..................................................................................... 3-10 Starting the Engine (Vehicle without Keyless Push Start System) .................. 3-11 Starting the Engine (Vehicle with Keyless Push Start System) ........................ 3-12 Using the Transaxle ............................................................ 3-15 Gearshift Indicator (if equipped) ........................................ 3-19 Parking Sensors (if equipped) ........................................... 3-20 Rearview Camera (if equipped) .......................................... 3-26 Braking ................................................................................. 3-29 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Exhaust Gas Warning WARNING EXAMPLE 52D334 WARNING Avoid breathing exhaust gases. Exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide, a potentially lethal gas that is colorless and odorless. Since carbon monoxide is difficult to detect by itself, be sure to take the following precautions to help prevent carbon monoxide from entering your vehicle. • Do not leave the engine running in garages or other confined areas. (Continued) (Continued) • Do not park with the engine running for a long period of time, even in an open area. If it is necessary to sit for a short time in a parked vehicle with the engine running, make sure the air intake selector is set to “FRESH AIR” and the blower is at high speed. • Avoid operating the vehicle with the tailgate or trunk open. If it is necessary to operate the vehicle with the tailgate or trunk open, make sure the sunroof (if equipped) and all windows are closed, and the blower is at high speed with the air intake selector set to “FRESH AIR”. • To allow proper operation of your vehicle’s ventilation system, keep the air inlet grille in front of the windshield clear of snow, leaves or other obstructions at all times. • Keep the exhaust tailpipe area clear of snow and other material to help reduce the buildup of exhaust gases under the vehicle. This is particularly important when parked in blizzard conditions. • Have the exhaust system inspected periodically for damage and leaks. Any damage or leaks should be repaired immediately. Daily Inspection Checklist Before Driving EXAMPLE 60A187S 1) Make sure that windows, mirrors, lights and reflectors are clean and unobstructed. 2) Visually check the tires for the following points: – the depth of the tread groove – abnormal wear, cracks and damage – loose wheel nuts – existence of foreign material such as nails, stones, etc. Refer to “Tires” in “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section for details. 3) Look for fluid and oil leaks. 3-1 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE NOTE: It is normal for water to drip from the air conditioning system after use. 4) Make sure the hood is fully closed and latched. 5) Check the headlights, turn signal lights, brake lights and horn for proper operation. 6) Adjust the seat and head restraint. 7) Check the brake pedal and the parking brake lever. 8) Adjust the mirrors. 9) Make sure that you and all passengers have properly fastened your seat belts. 10)Make sure that all warning lights come on as the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”. 11)Check all gauges. 12)Make sure that the BRAKE SYSTEM WARNING light turns off when the parking brake is released. Once a week, or each time you fill your fuel tank, perform the following under-hood checks: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) Engine oil level Coolant level Brake fluid level Battery solution level Windshield washer fluid level 6) Hood latch operation Pull the hood release handle inside the vehicle. Make sure that you cannot open the hood all the way without releasing the secondary latch. Be sure to close the hood securely after checking for proper latch operation. See the item “All latches, hinges and locks” of “CHASSIS AND BODY” in the “Periodic Maintenance Schedule” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section for lubrication schedule. WARNING Make sure the hood is fully closed and latched before driving. If it is not, it can fly up unexpectedly during driving, obstructing your view and resulting in an accident. Once a month, or each time you fill your fuel tank, check the tire pressure using a tire pressure gauge. Also check the tire pressure of the spare tire. Engine Oil Consumption It is normal for the engine to consume some engine oil during normal vehicle operation. The amount of engine oil consumed depends on the viscosity of the oil, the quality of the oil and the conditions the vehicle is driven under. More oil is consumed during high-speed driving and when there is frequent acceleration and deceleration. Under high loads, your engine also will consume more oil. A new engine also consumes more oil, since its pistons, piston rings and cylinder walls have not yet become conditioned. New engines reach the normal level of oil consumption only after approximately 5000 km driving. Oil consumption: Max. 1.0 L per 1000 km When judging the amount of oil consumption, note that the oil may become diluted and make it difficult to accurately judge the true oil level. As an example, if a vehicle is used for repeated short trips, and consumes a normal amount of oil, the dipstick may not show any drop in the oil level at all, even after 1000 km or more of driving. This is because the oil is gradually becoming diluted with fuel or moisture, making it appear that the oil level has not changed. 3-2 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE You should also be aware that the diluting ingredients evaporate out when the vehicle is subsequently driven at high speeds, such as on an expressway, making it appear that oil is excessively consumed after high-speed driving. Ignition Switch (Vehicle without Keyless Push Start System) The ignition switch has the following four positions: LOCK This is the normal parking position. It is the only position in which the key can be removed. EXAMPLE Manual transaxle EXAMPLE 65D611 Turn to “LOCK” Push WARNING To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the steering wheel. 68PH00301 EXAMPLE • Manual transaxle vehicles You must push in the key to turn it to the “LOCK” position. It locks the ignition, and prevents normal use of the steering wheel after the key is removed. • CVT vehicles The gearshift lever must be in the “P” (Park) position to turn the key to the “LOCK” position. It locks the ignition and prevents normal use of the steering wheel and gearshift lever. 68PH00310 3-3 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE To release the steering lock, insert the key and turn it clockwise to one of the other positions. If you have trouble turning the key to unlock the steering, try turning the steering wheel slightly to the right or left while turning the key. EXAMPLE WARNING ACC Accessories such as the radio can operate, but the engine is off. ON This is the normal operating position. All electrical systems are on. START This is the position for starting the engine using the starter motor. The key should be released from this position as soon as the engine starts. Ignition key reminder (if equipped) A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind you to remove the ignition key if it is in the ignition switch when the driver’s door is opened. 81A297S WARNING • Never return the ignition switch to the “LOCK” position and remove the ignition key while the vehicle is moving. The steering wheel will lock and you will not be able to steer the vehicle. (Continued) (Continued) • Always return the ignition switch to the “LOCK” position and remove the ignition key when leaving the vehicle even if only for a short time. Also do not leave children alone in a parked vehicle. Unattended children could cause accidental movement of the vehicle or could tamper with power windows. They also could suffer from heat stroke in warm or hot weather. These could result in severe injury or even death. NOTICE • Do not use the starter motor for more than 12 seconds at a time. If the engine does not start, wait 15 seconds before trying again. If the engine does not start after several attempts, check the fuel and ignition systems or consult your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. • Do not leave the ignition switch in the “ON” position if the engine is not running as the battery will discharge. 3-4 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Engine Switch (Vehicle with Keyless Push Start System) EXAMPLE ON • With the engine off You can use such electric equipment as the power windows and wipers with the engine off. When this ignition mode is selected by pressing the engine switch, the information display in the instrument cluster shows the following message: “ON” IGNITION SWITCH POSITION. • With the engine on All electric equipment is operational. The vehicle can be driven when you have selected this ignition mode by pressing the engine switch. 68PH00302 LOCK (OFF) This mode is for parking the vehicle. When this mode is selected by pressing the engine switch and then any door (including the tailgate) is opened or closed, the steering will be locked automatically. ACC Press the engine switch to select this ignition mode to use such electric equipment as the audio system, outside rearview mirrors and accessory socket with the engine off. When this position is selected, the information display in the instrument cluster shows the following message: “ACC” IGNITION SWITCH POSITION. Refer to “Information Display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details. START Provided you have the keyless push start system remote controller with you, the engine automatically starts when you press the engine switch to select this ignition mode after shifting to “N” (Neutral) and depressing the brake and clutch pedals. NOTE: You do not need to keep the engine switch pressed to start the engine. NOTE: In the presence of strong radio signals or noise, you may not be able to change the ignition mode to “ACC” or “ON” or to start the engine using the engine switch. In this case, the information display on the instrument cluster will show the following message: KEY FOB NOT DETECTED. Unreleased Steering Lock Warning If the steering lock remains engaged when you press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “ON”, the information display in the instrument cluster shows the message: “TRN. STEERING WHEEL TO RELEASE LOCK”. Refer to “Information Display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details. NOTE: The steering lock may not be released if some load is acting on the steering wheel. If this happens, turn the steering wheel to the right or left to relieve it from the load before you press the engine switch again to change to the desired ignition mode. NOTICE Do not leave the engine switch in the “ACC” or “ON” mode when the engine is not running. Avoid using the radio or other electric accessories for a long time when the engine switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” mode when the engine is not running, otherwise the battery may discharge. 3-5 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Keyless Push Start System (if equipped) Provided the keyless push start system remote controller is within the “interior workable area” (refer to the related explanation in this section), you can use the engine switch for starting the engine and selecting an ignition mode (“ACC” or “ON”). In addition, the following functions can be used: • Keyless entry function. Refer to “Keyless Push Start System Remote Controller” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details. • Locking and unlocking doors (including the tailgate) using a request switch. Refer to “Keyless Push Start System Remote Controller” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details. • Immobilizer (anti-theft) function. Refer to “Immobilizer System” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details. Engine Switch Illumination The engine switch is illuminated (lit) in the following situations: • When the engine is off and the driver’s door is open, or for 15 seconds after the driver’s door is closed. The illumination will fade out after 15 seconds pass. • When the engine is off and the position lights are on. The illumination will go out when the position lights are turned off. • When the engine is on and the position lights and/or the headlights are on. The illumination will go out when the position lights and/or the headlights are turned off. 1) Bring the keyless push start system remote controller with you and sit in the driver’s seat. 2) Without depressing the clutch pedal, press the engine switch (1). EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 82K253 NOTE: To save the battery, the illumination will be automatically turned off when both of the following conditions are simultaneously met: • The headlights and position lights are turned off. • A period of 15 minutes has elapsed after opening the driver’s door. (1) 68PH00303 Every time you press the engine switch, the ignition mode changes as follows. EXAMPLE Selection of Ignition Modes Press the engine switch to select the “ACC” or “ON” mode as follows when you use an electric accessory or check the operation of instruments without running the engine. (OFF) (Audio equipment) 68PH00322 3-6 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE NOTE: When selecting the ignition modes, the information display in the instrument clustershows certain messages. Refer to “Information Display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details. If the master warning indicator light blinks and the ignition modes cannot be selected Your keyless push start system remote controller may not be sensed as being within the “interior workable area” (refer to the related explanation in this section). Try again after making sure you have the remote controller with you. If the ignition modes still cannot be selected, the battery of the remote controller may be discharged. To be able to select an ignition mode, you must then use the following method: EXAMPLE (1) (2) 68PH00304 1) Without depressing the brake pedal and the clutch pedal, push the engine switch (1). 2) Within about 10 seconds during which the master warning indicator light in the instrument cluster is blinking and the “PLACE KEY FOB ON START SWITCH” message appears on the information display, touch the engine switch with the “LOCK” button end of the remote controller (2) for about 2 seconds. Then you should be able to select ignition modes. NOTE: • If you still cannot select the ignition modes, there may be some problem with the keyless push start system. Contact an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for an inspection of the system. • The immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light will come on for about 5 seconds while the master warning indicator light is blinking in addition, the information display in the instrument cluster will show a message during this time. Refer to “Information Display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details. • You may customize the system to cause the interior buzzer to sound once for the “remote controller out of sensing range” warning. To incorporate this customization, please contact an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. • If the battery of the remote controller is about to become completely discharged, the corresponding message will appear on the information display when you press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “ON”. Refer to “Information Display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details. For details on replacing the battery, refer to the “Keyless Push Start System Remote Controller” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section. “Remote Controller Outside” Warning When either of the conditions described below is met, the system issues a “remote controller outside” warning by sounding the interior and exterior buzzers.At the same time the immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light comes on and the master warning indicator light blinks. • Any door is opened and then closed while the remote controller is not inside the vehicle and the engine is running or the ignition mode has been changed to “ACC” or “ON” by pressing the engine switch. • The remote controller is not inside the vehicle when you attempt to start the engine after changing the ignition mode to “ACC” or “ON” by pressing the engine switch. 3-7 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE (OFF) by pressing the engine switch and then perform the engine starting operation Refer to “Starting the Engine” in this section. • Always keep the remote controller with you as the driver. EXAMPLE (2) Interior Workable Area for Engine Starting, Ignition Mode Selection and “Remote Controller Outside” Warning EXAMPLE (1) (1) 68PH02305 (1) Immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light (blinks) (2) Master warning indicator light (blinks) NOTE: • If the warning is given, locate the remote controller as soon as possible. • Any attempt to start the engine will fail while the warning is active. The message appearing on the information display in the instrument cluster will also indicate this condition. Refer to “Information Display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details. • Normally the immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light should go out and the master warning indicator light should stop blinking shortly after the remote controller is brought back inside the vehicle. If they remain lit and blinking, change the ignition mode to “LOCK” 68PH00306 (1) Interior workable area The “interior workable area” for these functions is defined as all the interior spaces except for the space above the instrument panel. NOTE: • Even when the remote controller is in the “interior workable area”, if it is in any of the following conditions, you may not be able to start the engine or select the ignition modes, and the “remote controller outside” warning may be given. –The remote controller’s battery is low. –The remote controller is affected by strong radio signals or noise. –The remote controller is in contact with or covered by a metallic object. 3-8 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE –The remote controller is in stowage like the glove box or a door pocket. –The remote controller is in the sun visor pocket or on the floor. • Even when the remote controller is outside the “interior workable area”, if it is in any of the following conditions, you may be able to start the engine or select the ignition mode. The “remote controller outside” warning may not be given at that time. –The remote controller is outside the vehicle but very close to a door. –The remote controller is on the instrument panel. Parking Brake Lever may make it difficult to shift out of “P” when you are ready to drive the vehicle. When preparing to drive the vehicle, move the gearshift lever out of the “P” position before releasing the parking brake. EXAMPLE (1) (2) (3) 68PHM3001 (1) To set (2) To release (3) To release The parking brake lever is located between the seats. To set the parking brake, hold the brake pedal down and pull the parking brake lever all the way up. To release the parking brake, hold the brake pedal down, pull up slightly on the parking brake lever, push the button on the end of the lever with your thumb, and lower the lever to its original position. For CVT vehicles, always set the parking brake before moving the gearshift lever to the “P” (Park) position. If you park on an incline and shift into “P” before setting the parking brake, the weight of the vehicle WARNING • Never drive your vehicle with the parking brake on: rear brake effectiveness can be reduced from overheating, brake life may be shortened, or permanent brake damage may result. • If the parking brake does not hold the vehicle securely or does not fully release, have your vehicle inspected immediately by authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. WARNING Always set the parking brake fully before leaving your vehicle or it may move, causing injury or damage. When parking, make sure the gearshift lever for manual transaxle vehicles is in reverse or first gear and the gearshift lever for CVT vehicles is in “P” (Park). Remember, even though the transaxle is in gear or in Park, you must set the parking brake fully. 3-9 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE WARNING When parking the vehicle in extremely cold weather, the following procedure should be used: 1) Set the parking brake. 2) Manual transaxle - turn off the engine, then shift into reverse or first gear. CVT - shift into “P” (Park) and turn off the engine. 3) Get out of the vehicle and put chocks under the wheels. 4) Release the parking brake. When you return to your vehicle, you must remember to first set the parking brake, then remove the wheel chocks. Pedal (1) (2) EXAMPLE (3) 80J2121 CVT Your vehicle is equipped with front disc brakes and rear drum brakes. Depressing the brake pedal applies both sets of brakes. You may hear occasional brake squeal when you apply the brakes. This is a normal condition caused by environmental factors such as cold, wet, snow, etc. WARNING If brake squeal is excessive and occurs each time the brakes are applied, you should have the brakes checked by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. EXAMPLE (2) (3) Parking Brake Reminder Buzzer A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind you to release the parking brake if you start the vehicle without releasing the parking brake. Make sure that the parking brake is fully released and the brake system warning light turns off. Brake Pedal (2) Manual transaxle 80J2122 Clutch Pedal (1) (For manual transaxle) The clutch pedal is used to disengage the drive to the wheels when starting the engine, stopping, or shifting the gearshift lever. Depressing the pedal disengages the clutch. WARNING Do not drive with your foot resting on the clutch pedal. It could result in excessive clutch wear, clutch damage, or unexpected loss of engine braking. WARNING Do not “ride” the brakes by applying them continuously or resting your foot on the pedal. This will result in overheating of the brakes which could cause unpredictable braking action, longer stopping distances, or permanent brake damage. Accelerator Pedal (3) This pedal controls the speed of the engine. Depressing the accelerator pedal increases power output and speed. 3-10 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Starting the Engine (Vehicle without Keyless Push Start System) Before Starting the Engine NOTE: CVT vehicles have a starter interlock device which is designed to keep the starter from operating if the transaxle is in any of the drive positions. WARNING Make sure that the parking brake is set fully and the transaxle is in Neutral (or Park for vehicles with CVT) before attempting to start the engine. NOTE: The engine of manual transaxle vehicle will not start unless the clutch pedal is depressed. EXAMPLE 68PH00308 1) Make sure the parking brake is set fully. 2) Manual transaxle – Shift into “N” (Neutral) and depress the clutch pedal all the way to the floor. Hold the clutch pedal while starting the engine. CVT – If the gearshift lever is not in “P” (Park) position, shift into “P” (Park). (If you need to re-start the engine while the vehicle is moving, shift into “N”.) Starting a Cold and Warm Engine (For Petrol Engine Model) With your foot off the accelerator pedal, crank the engine by turning the ignition key to “START”. Release the key when the engine starts. NOTICE • Stop turning the starter immediately after the engine has started or the starter system can be damaged. • Do not crank the engine for more than 12 seconds at a time. If the engine doesn’t start on the first try, wait about 15 seconds before trying again. If the engine does not start after 12 seconds of cranking, wait about 15 seconds, then press down the accelerator pedal to 1/3 of its travel and try cranking the engine again. Release the key and accelerator pedal when the engine starts. If the engine still does not start, try holding the accelerator pedal all the way down to the floor while cranking. This should clear the engine if it is flooded. (For Diesel Engine Model) Cold engine Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position and wait until the glow plug indicator goes out if it comes on. Crank the engine by turning the ignition key to “START”. Release the key when the engine starts. NOTICE • Stop turning the starter immediately after the engine has started or the starter system can be damaged. • Do not crank the engine for more than 30 seconds at a time. If the engine doesn’t start on the first try, wait about 15 seconds before trying again. Warm engine Crank the engine by turning the ignition key to “START”. Release the key when the engine starts. 3-11 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Caution when stopping the engine with turbocharger When stopping the engine after climbing or high speed driving, let the engine idle for about one minute or more (if it is not prohibited) to cool down the turbocharger and engine oil. This is to prevent the engine oil from over-deteriorating. Deteriorated engine oil will damage the bearings of the turbocharger. Restarting diesel engine after fuelempty stop If the engine stops and the low fuel warning light and the malfunction indicator light come on, use the following procedure: 1) Fill the fuel tank. 2) Hold the ignition key in “ON” position for 5-10 seconds to feed fuel. 3) Perform above engine starting procedure to start the engine. If the malfunction indicator light still comes on after the engine started, there may be some problem with the engine. Ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to have the engine inspected. Starting the Engine (Vehicle with Keyless Push Start System) Before Starting the Engine EXAMPLE 3) The “PUSH START SWITCH” message will appear on the information display in the instrument cluster. Push the engine switch (1). When the engine is started, the starter motor will automatically stop. WARNING Make sure that the parking brake is set fully and the transaxle is in “N” (Neutral) before attempting to start the engine. NOTICE 68PH00309 1) Make sure the parking brake is set fully. 2) Shift to “N” (Neutral) and fully depress the clutch pedal. Hold the clutch and brake pedals fully depressed. NOTE: The engine of manual transaxle vehicle will not start unless the clutch pedal is depressed. NOTE: The engine of manual transaxle vehicle will not start unless the clutch pedal is depressed. EXAMPLE (1) • Do not depress the accelerator during the engine starting procedure. • If the engine does not respond when you try to start it with the engine switch or if the engine switch repeats cycling through the “LOCK”(OFF) - “ACC” - “ON” mode, the vehicle battery may be discharged. Check the voltage of the vehicle battery before trying again. NOTE: • You do not need to keep the engine switch pressed to start the engine. • The engine of a manual transaxle vehicle will not start unless the clutch pedal is depressed. • During the engine starting procedure, messages on the information display will 68PH00303 3-12 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE help you. Refer to “Information Display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details. • You should turn off such loads as the headlights and air conditioning system to facilitate starting of the engine. • Even if you fail to start the engine, the starter motor will stop turning automatically after a short time. After the starter motor has stopped or if there is some problem with the system, the starter motor will rotate only while the engine switch is being pressed. Stopping the engine • Depress the engine switch to stop the engine after the vehicle stopped completely. • In case of emergency, you can stop the engine by quickly pushing the engine switch more than 3 times, or pushing and holding the engine switch more than 2 seconds while the vehicle in motion. NOTE: Except in emergency, do not stop the engine while the vehicle is in motion. The steering and braking operation will require more efforts when the engine is stopped. Refer to “Braking” in this section. • If the vehicle is stopped & stays as it is for while after the engine was stopped unexpectedly or was raced before stopping, a clicking sound may be heard from around the engine when the engine is restarted. This is not a malfunction. In such cases, always let the engine idle before stopping it. Starting a Cold and Warm Engine (For Petrol Engine Model) With your foot off the accelerator pedal, crank the engine by pressing the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “START”. NOTICE Do not crank the engine for more than 12 seconds at a time. If the engine doesn’t start on the first try, wait about 15 seconds before trying again. After pressing the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “START”, the starter cranks the engine for about 12 seconds before it can start the engine. If the engine fails to start at the first attempt, wait about 15 seconds, then try again while keeping the engine switch pressed while pressing down the accelerator pedal to 1/3 of its travel. Release the accelerator pedal when the engine starts. If the engine still does not start, try holding the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor while cranking. This should clear the engine if it is flooded. If you are unable to start the engine using this procedure, consult your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. (For Diesel Engine Model) Cold engine Depress the clutch and brake pedals fully and press the engine switch to crank the engine. If the glow plug indicator light comes on, the engine will start automatically after the glow plug indicator light goes off or 10 seconds pass. NOTICE Do not crank the engine for more than 30 seconds at a time. If the engine doesn’t start on the first try, wait about 15 seconds before trying again. Warm engine Crank the engine by pressing the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “START”. Caution when stopping the engine with turbocharger When stopping the engine after climbing or high speed driving, let the engine idle for about one minute or more (if it is not prohibited) to cool down the turbocharger and engine oil. This is to prevent the engine oil from over-deteriorating. Deteriorated engine oil will damage the bearings of the turbocharger. 3-13 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Restarting diesel engine after fuelempty stop If the engine stops and the low fuel warning light and the malfunction indicator light come on, use the following procedure: 1) Fill the fuel tank. 2) Press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “ON” for 5-10 seconds to feed fuel. 3) Perform above engine starting procedure to start the engine. If the malfunction indicator light still comes on after the engine started, there may be some problem with the engine. Ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to have the engine inspected. If the master warning indicator light blinks and the engine cannot be started Your keyless push start system remote controller may not be sensed as being within the “interior workable area”. Try again after making sure that you have the remote controller with you. If the engine still cannot be started, the battery of the remote controller may be discharged. You must then use the following method to be able to start the engine. EXAMPLE (1) (2) 68PH00304 1) Make sure the parking brake is set fully. 2) Shift to “N” (Neutral) and fully depress the clutch pedal. Hold the clutch and brake pedals fully depressed. 3) The “PUSH START SWITCH” message will appear on the information display in the instrument cluster. Press the engine switch (1). 4) Within about 10 seconds of blinking of the master warning indicator light in the instrument cluster, touch the engine switch with the “LOCK” button end of the remote controller (2) for about 2 seconds.Then you should be able to select ignition modes & start the engine. NOTE: • If you still cannot start the engine after several attempts using the above method, there may be a problem elsewhere, such as a low battery. Contact your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for inspection. • The immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light will come on for about 5 seconds while the master warning indicator light is blinking. In addition, the information display will show a certain message during this time. Refer to “Information Display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details. • You may customize the system to cause the interior buzzer to sound once for the “remote controller out of sensing range” warning. Please contact an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for the customization. • If the battery of the remote controller is about to be completely discharged, a message warning will appear on the information display when the ignition mode is changed to “ON” by pressing the engine switch. For details on replacing the battery, refer to the “Keyless Push Start System Remote Controller” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section. Returning the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF) NOTE: Certain problems like a fault in engine system may prevent the engine switch from going back to the “LOCK” (OFF) mode. If this happens, have the vehicle inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop after doing the following: • Lock the doors using the key to prevent theft. (The request switches and the key- 3-14 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE less push start system remote controller cannot be used to lock them.) • Disconnect the negative cable from the battery to prevent discharge. “LOCK” (OFF) mode reminder buzzer If the driver’s door is opened without returning the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF) by pressing the engine switch, a buzzer sounds to warn you of this state. • If you open the driver’s door after pressing the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “ACC”, the interior buzzer beeps intermittently. • The buzzer will stop sounding if you then push the engine switch twice, thus bringing it back the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF). NOTE: Whenever you leave the vehicle, make sure you have returned the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF) using the engine switch and then lock the doors. Without returning the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF), you cannot use a request switch or keyless push start system remote controller to lock the doors. Steering lock warning buzzer If the steering lock fails to engage due to a fault in the system when the ignition mode is turned to “LOCK” (OFF) by pressing the engine switch and then any door (including the tailgate) is opened or closed, the interior buzzer will warn you of this condition with repeated short beeps. If this happens, have the vehicle inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Using the Transaxle Manual Transaxle EXAMPLE 79MH0303 Starting off To start off, depress the clutch pedal all the way to the floor and shift into 1st gear. After releasing the parking brake, gradually release the clutch. When you hear a change in the engine’s sound, slowly press the accelerator while continuing to gradually release the clutch. Shifting All forward gears are synchronized, which provides for quiet, and easy shifting. Always depress the clutch pedal all the way to the floor before shifting gears. Keep the engine speed to a value so that it does not rise into the red zone of the tachometer. 3-15 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Downshifting speeds maximum allowable WARNING For Petrol Engine Downshifting km/h (mph) 2nd to 1st 45 (28) 3rd to 2nd 85 (53) 4th to 3rd 130 (81) 5th to 4th 175 (109)* For Diesel engine Downshifting km/h (mph) 2nd to 1st 40 (25) 3rd to 2nd 70 (44) 4th to 3rd 115 (72) 5th to 4th 165 (103)* *NOTE: You may not accelerate to the maximum allowable speed because of the driving situation and/or the vehicle condition. NOTICE When downshifting to a lower gear, make sure not to downshift at the speed faster than the maximum allowable speeds for the next lower speed, or severe engine damage can result. • Reduce your speed and downshift to a lower gear before going down a long or steep hill. A lower gear will allow the engine to provide braking. Avoid riding the brakes or they may overheat, resulting in brake failure. • When driving on slippery roads, be sure to slow down before downshifting. Excessive and/or sudden changes in engine speed may cause loss of traction, which could cause you to lose control. NOTICE Make sure that the vehicle is completely stationary before you shift into reverse. Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT) EXAMPLE (1) 68PH00311 (1) S (sport) mode switch EXAMPLE NOTICE • To help avoid clutch damage, do not use the clutch pedal as a footrest while driving or use the clutch to keep the vehicle stationary on a slope. Depress the clutch fully when shifting. • When shifting or starting off, do not race the engine. Racing the engine can shorten engine life and cause negative effect to smooth shifting. (2) 68PH00312 (2) Sport mode indicator S (sport) mode switch The sport mode switch (1) is used to turn on and off the sport mode. To turn on the sport mode, push in the switch and sport mode indicator (2) will appear on the information display. To turn off the sport mode, push in the switch again and sport mode indicator will go off. 3-16 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE When the engine restarts, the sport mode is turned to the off automatically. The sport mode is suitable for the following driving conditions: • Driving on hilly, winding roads – You can drive more smoothly with less frequent gear changing • Going down a steep hill – Some engine braking is provided WARNING Always depress the brake pedal before shifting from “P” (Park) (or “N” (Neutral) if the vehicle is stationary) to a forward or reverse gear, to help prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly when you shift. The gearshift lever has a lock mechanism to help prevent accidental shifting. To shift the gearshift lever: Gearshift lever EXAMPLE Shift with the knob button (1) pushed in and the brake pedal depressed. (1) Shift with the knob button (1) pushed in. Shift without the knob button (1) pushed in. 68PH00313 (1) Knob button The gearshift lever is designed so that it cannot be shifted out of the “P” position unless the ignition switch is in the “ON” position and the brake pedal is depressed. NOTE: • Always shift the gearshift lever without pushing in the knob button (1) except when you shift from “P” to “R”, from “D” to “L”, from “N” to “R” or from “R” to “P”. If you always push in the knob button (1) when shifting the gearshift lever, you could shift into “P”, “R” or “L” by mistake. • If driver’s or passenger’s knee hits the gearshift lever while driving, the lever could move and the gear could be changed unexpectedly. Use the gearshift lever positions as described below: P (Park) Use this position to lock the transaxle when the vehicle is parked or when starting the engine. Shift into Park only when the vehicle is completely stationary. R (Reverse) Use this position to reverse the vehicle from stop. Make sure that vehicle is completely stationary before shifting into Reverse. NOTICE Do not shift the gearshift lever into “R” while moving forward, or the transaxle may be damaged. If you shift into “R” when the vehicle speed is over 10 km/h (6 mph), the transaxle will not shift into reverse. N (Neutral) Use this position for starting the engine if the engine stalls and you need to restart it while the vehicle is moving. You may also shift into Neutral and depress the brake pedal to hold the vehicle stationary during idling. 3-17 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE D (Drive) Use this position for all normal driving. With the gearshift lever in “D” range you can get an automatic downshift by pressing the accelerator pedal. The higher the vehicle speed is, the more you need to press the accelerator pedal to get a downshift. L (Low) Use this position to provide maximum power when climbing steep hills or driving through deep snow or mud, or to provide maximum engine braking when going down steep hills. NOTICE (Continued) • Do not rev the engine with the transaxle in a drive position (“R”, “D”, or “L”) and the front wheels not moving. • Do not use the accelerator to hold the vehicle on a hill. Use the vehicle’s brakes. If You Cannot Shift CVT Gearshift Lever Out of “P” (Park) NOTE: If you move the gearshift lever to a lower gear while driving faster than the maximum allowable speed for the lower gear, the transaxle will not actually downshift until your speed drops below the maximum speed for the lower gear. follow the procedure described below. This procedure will permit shifting the transaxle out of Park. 1) Be sure the parking brake is firmly applied. 2) If the engine is running, stop the engine. 3) Make sure the key is in the “ON” or “ACC” position. 4) With the release button (1) pushed, push the knob button (2) and shift the gearshift lever to the desired position. This procedure is for emergency use only. If repeated use of this procedure is necessary, or the procedure does not work as described, take the vehicle to your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for repair. (2) (1) NOTICE Be sure to take the following precautions to help avoid damage to the CVT: • Make sure that the vehicle is completely stationary before shifting into “P” or “R”. • Do not shift from “P” or “N” to “R”, “D”, or “L” when the engine is running above idle speed. (Continued) EXAMPLE 68PH00314 Vehicles with a CVT have an electrically operated park-lock feature. If the vehicle’s battery is discharged, or there is some other electrical failure, the CVT cannot be shifted out of Park in the normal way. Jump starting may correct the condition. If not, 3-18 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Gearshift Indicator (if equipped) For details on how to use the transaxle, refer to “Using the Transaxle” in this section. EXAMPLE WARNING 68PH02218 In the following cases, the gearshift indicator is indicated on the information display when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position or the ignition mode is “ON”. When the gearshift lever is in a position other than “N” (Neutral). The electronic control system monitors driving condition (such as vehicle speed and/or engine revolution), and it shows which gear position is optimal for your driving with the indication on the display. If UP/DOWN arrow and the gear position other than currently selected are indicated on the display while driving, we recommend you to shift up or down the gear to indicated position. It is the optimal gear position for a driving condition that reduces the over revolution and stress to the engine, and improves fuel consumption. The gearshift indicator is designed to indicate optimal gear position for your driving, however, a driver will not be relieved from the duty of care of driving operation or gear change with this indicator. To drive safe, do not gaze the gearshift indicator, pay attention to your driving situation and shift up or down if necessary. NOTE: • The gearshift indicator is not indicated when the gear position is in “N” (Neutral). • If you depress the clutch pedal while UP/ DOWN arrow is indicated, the indication will disappear. • If you release your foot from the accelerator pedal while UP arrow is indicated, the indication will display the currently selected gear position. • The indication of gearshift indicator timing may differ depending on the vehicle condition and/or driving situation even in the same vehicle speed and engine revolution. 3-19 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Parking Sensors (if equipped) Example of the gearshift indicator Indication Description Lower gear position is selected for the vehicle speed and/or engine revolution. Changing to a higher gear position is recommended. • In this case, shifting up to 4th gear position is recommended. Information display symbol (if equipped) EXAMPLE Currently selected gear position is indicated. • In this case, your vehicle is running in 3rd gear position. Higher gear position is selected for the vehicle speed and/or engine revolution. Changing to a lower gear position is recommended. • In this case, shifting down to 4th gear position is recommended. (1) 68PH02301 (1) Symbol representing an obstacle detected by parking sensor* * This symbol shows that an obstacle is located on the right rear of vehicle. • The parking sensor system uses ultrasonic sensors to detect obstacles near the rear bumper. If obstacles are sensed while you are parking or moving the vehicle slowly, the system warns you by sounding a buzzer and displaying symbols representing the obstacles on the information display in the instrument cluster (if equipped). 3-20 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE • The system emits an ultrasonic wave and the relevant sensor detects the return of the wave reflected by an obstacle. The system measures the time taken by the ultrasonic wave to reach the obstacle and return from it, from which it determines the obstacle’s position. • The parking sensor function can be used when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”, the gearshift lever is in the “R” position and the parking sensor switch is in the “ON” position. This function is helpful in the following cases: pulling over to the curb; parallel-parking the vehicle; steering the vehicle into a garage; driving along an alley; and moving slowly in a place with obstacles. WARNING (Continued) • The sensors can detect obstacles only within a limited area and only when the vehicle is moving within a limited speed range. So, in tricky areas, you must move the vehicle slowly while checking around it using your direct vision or rearview mirrors. There is increased risk of an accident if you control the vehicle relying only on the parking sensor. NOTICE • Avoid hitting the sensor areas or directing the nozzle of a high-pressure car washer onto the sensor areas. Otherwise, the sensors may be damaged. • If the bumper hits a hard object, the sensors on it may not work properly. If this occurs, have the sensors inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Sensor Locations EXAMPLE WARNING • The parking sensor warns you of obstacles with buzzers and by showing you the location of the obstacles on the information display (if equipped). However, you must still pay full attention yourself while driving. (Continued) (2) (1) (1) (2) 68PH00320 (1) Rear center sensors (2 places) (2) Rear corner sensors (2 places) 3-21 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Working sensors The sensors that work depends on the position of the gearshift lever as follows: Gearshift lever position Rear sensors Manual transaxle Approximate areas where obstacles can be detected EXAMPLE CVT R N, 1st – 5th R N, D or L Center On Off On Off Corner On Off On Off 68PH00321 • An obstacle within about 20 cm (8 in) from a sensor or just below a sensor is not detectable. • The sensors can detect an obstacle up to about 1.5 m (5 ft) from the rear of vehicle. 3-22 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE WARNING • Under the following conditions, the parking sensor system may not work normally because the sensors cannot detect obstacles correctly. – Sensors are covered with mud, ice or other materials. (Such materials must be removed for normal operation.) – Sensors are wet from water splashes or heavy rain. – Sensors are covered by a hand, sticker, accessory, etc. – There is an accessory or other object attached within the sensor’s sensing area. – Items such as tow hooks, commercially available corner poles, radio antenna, etc. are installed on the bumper. – The height of the bumper is changed due to alteration to the suspension or other causes. – The sensor areas are extremely hot from direct sunlight or cold due to freezing weather. – The vehicle is on a rough surface, slope, gravel road or grass field. – The vehicle is at a steep angle. (Continued) WARNING (Continued) – Sensors have intercepted ultrasonic noise from another vehicle’s horn, engine, air braking system (large vehicles), or parking sensor. – Obstacles are too close to the sensors. – Sensors are at an angle to a highly reflective object such as glass. (Ultrasonic waves are not reflected back from the obstacle.) • Sensors may not be able to correctly detect the following types of obstacles: – Objects made of a thin material like wire netting and ropes – Square-shaped curbstones or other objects with sharp edges – Tall objects with a large upper part like a road sign – Low-profile objects such as curbstones – Sound-absorbing objects such as cotton and snow NOTE: • Thin poles or obstacles lower than the sensors may become undetectable as the vehicle moves closer to them even if they have been detected from longer distances. • The system may calculate the distance to a road sign or similar obstacle to be shorter than the actual distance. How to Use the Parking Sensor Parking sensor switch (2) (1) EXAMPLE 54P000315 (1) Parking sensor switch (2) Indicator 3-23 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE • Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position or press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “ON” with the parking sensor switch in the “ON” position. • Push the switch again and it stays in; this is the OFF position. The indicator in the switch goes out and the parking sensor is deactivated. Switch position State Obstacle Indication by Parking Sensor Information display symbol (if equipped) EXAMPLE EXAMPLE ON • When the indicator light is on and all necessary conditions are met, system becomes ready for operation. EXAMPLE OFF • The system does not operate. Push the switch to turn off the indicator if you do not wish to use the parking sensor. (2) (1) (2) 68PH02302 NOTE: • If you push the parking sensor switch from the “OFF” to “ON” position when the ignition switch is turned to “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to change the ignition mode to “ON”, the inside buzzer sounds. • When the gearshift lever is shifted to the “R” (Reverse) position with the system ON, a buzzer will sound once. (1) Obstacle detected by rear center sensors (2) Obstacle detected by rear corner sensors Upon detecting an obstacle, the parking sensor causes an interior buzzer to sound and a symbol representing the obstacle appears on the information display in the instrument cluster (if equipped). • A different symbol is displayed depending on the direction and distance of the obstacle. (if equipped) • A buzzer located behind the rear seat sounds when a sensor at the rear detects an obstacle. 3-24 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Set Sensors (if equipped) • Warnings when obstacles are detected by corner sensors Distance (approx.) Buzzer Symbol (if equipped) 45 – 60 cm (18 – 24 in.) Short beeps at short intervals Three lines 35 – 45 cm (14 – 18 in.) Short beeps at very short intervals Two lines Less than 35 cm (14 in.) Continuous beep One line • Warnings when obstacles are detected by center sensors Symbol (if equipped) Distance (approx.) Buzzer 60 – 150 cm (24 – 59 in.) Short beeps at long intervals 45 – 60 cm (18 – 24 in.) Short beeps at short intervals 35 – 45 cm (14 – 18 in.) Short beeps at very short intervals Two lines Less than 35 cm (14 in.) Continuous beep One line Three lines You can select either the normal or trailer mode of the parking sensor via the information display. Refer to “Information display” in “BEFORE DRIVING” section. Normal mode All sensors operate. Use this mode under normal conditions. Trailer mode The rear corner and rear center sensors are inhibited from operating. Use this mode when towing a trailer. NOTICE Check that the normal mode is selected with the parking sensor when steering the vehicle into a garage. If the parking sensor is left in the trailer mode, the rear corner and rear center sensors are not functioning. NOTE: • Symbols are displayed with a short delay after the detection of obstacles. • If the system detects multiple obstacles simultaneously, the display shows all of their positions using the corresponding symbols. However, the buzzers will sound only for the nearest obstacles. 3-25 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Warning and Indicator Messages Vehicle without the information display symbol If there is a problem or warning regarding the parking sensor system, a buzzer and the status of the indicator on the parking sensor switch inform it. Follow its instruction. • The buzzer sounds intermittently. The indicated sensor is contaminated. Wipe it clean with a soft cloth. If the buzzer does not stop after wiping, there may be problem with the parking sensor system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. • The indicator does not come on when the parking sensor switch is pressed. The indicator goes off while operating. There may be a problem with the parking sensor system, Have your vehicle inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Vehicle with the information display symbol If there is a problem or warning regarding the parking sensor system, a message is displayed on the information display in the instrument cluster, and a symbol blinks and the buzzer sounds. If a message is displayed, follow its instruction. Message Symbol Buzzer Probable cause and remedy Two blinking Series of There may be a problem with the lines in a sensor double beeps parking sensor system. location. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. One blinking line Series of sin- The indicated sensor is contamiin a sensor loca- gle beeps nated. tion. Wipe it clean with a soft cloth. Rearview Camera (if equipped) When the gearshift lever is shifted to the “R” position while the ignition mode is “ON”, the rearview camera system automatically shows the view behind the vehicle on the display. WARNING The distance viewed in the rearview camera may differ from the actual distance according to the condition of road or the load the vehicle is carrying. Since the camera display area is also limited, backing up by only looking at the display may cause an accident or a collision with an object. The rearview camera cannot replace the driver’s attention. The driver alone is responsible for parking and similar driving maneuvers. • Use the rearview camera only to provide driving assistance. • Always drive carefully confirming the safety of the rear and the surrounding conditions by looking directly with your eyes and using the rear view mirror. • Make sure that the tailgate is securely closed when backing up. 3-26 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE NOTICE NOTICE If you use the rearview camera for a long time when the ignition mode is “ON”, but the engine is not running, the battery may discharge. Do not leave the ignition mode “ON” for a long time when the engine is not running. The rearview camera is a precision instrument. If you strike the camera, it may be broken and cause damage resulting in a catching fire or a malfunction. • Do not strike the camera. • Do not remove snow or mud on the camera lens with a stick. Rearview Camera Location NOTICE If water enters the rearview camera, it may cause a malfunction or catching fire. Do not use high pressure water around the camera. NOTICE (1) EXAMPLE 68PH00315 (1) Rearview camera The rearview camera is installed beside the license plate light. This lens is hard coated to prevent damage or discoloration. Damage or discoloration of lens may obscure the image. • Do not use a brush to clean lens. • Do not use alcohol, benzene or thinner to clean the lens. • Do not use wax on the camera lens. How to Use Rearview Camera 1) Press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “ON”. 2) Shift the gearshift lever in the “R” position. • The display automatically shows the view behind the vehicle. • When the gearshift lever is shifted from “R” to another gearshift lever position, the display returns to the previous display. NOTE: The rearview camera display has first priority in any display mode. However, the rearview camera display does not show the rear view while the system is initializing. Display Range of Rearview Camera The rearview camera display shows the area behind the rear end of the tailgate. The display cannot show objects which are close to the bumper or under the bumper. The rearview camera display cannot show obstacles which are higher than the camera. Upper parts of tall objects such as road signs cannot be viewed on the display. NOTE: If body wax does get on the camera lens, wipe off the wax with a clean cloth dampened with mild detergent diluted with water, then wipe with a dry cloth. 3-27 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Example of display range of rearview camera (1) EXAMPLE 68PH00316 EXAMPLE (1) 68PH00317 (1) Display range NOTE: • Images shown on the display from the rearview camera are reversed images (mirror images). • The colors of objects on the rearview camera may differ from the actual object colors. • The rearview camera display may be difficult to see under the following conditions, but this is not a system malfunction. – In dark areas, on a rainy day or at night. – When the temperature around the lens is too high/low, or the camera is wet such as on a rainy day or during periods of high humidity (dew condensation may occur on the camera lens). – When a foreign object such as mud or a drop of water is stuck around the camera lens. – When strong light directly enters the camera (vertical lines may be seen on the display). – Under fluorescent light. (The display may flicker.) – When the outside temperature is low (the image on the display may be darkened). Example of rearview camera screen indication The distance viewed in the rearview camerdiffer from the actual distance according to the condition of the road or the load the vehicle is carrying. Uphill incline behind the vehicle EXAMPLE (1) (1) Object (2) Actual distance (3) Distance on the display When there is an uphill incline behind the vehicle, the object shown on the display appears farther away than the actual distance. Downhill incline behind the vehicle EXAMPLE (1) (3) (2) 68PH00319 (1) Object (2) Actual distance (3) Distance on the display When there is a downhill incline behind the vehicle, the object shown on the display appears closer than the actual distance. (2) (3) 68PH00318 3-28 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE If the rear view from the rearview camera is not shown or there is a poor image • If the rear view from the rearview camera is not shown. – Check to make sure that the ignition mode is “ON”. – Check to make sure that the gearshift lever is shifted to the “R” position. • If the image from the rearview camera is poor. – Check to make sure that the camera lens is not dirty. – Check to make sure that light from the sun or the beam of the headlights from the vehicle behind is not shining directly into the lens. If the rearview camera system is still not working properly after checking the above, have the system inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible. Braking WARNING EXAMPLE If water gets into the brake devices, brake performance may become poor and unpredictable. After driving through water or washing the underside of the vehicle, test the brakes while driving at a slow speed to see if they have maintained their normal effectiveness. If the brakes are less effective than normal, dry them by repeatedly applying the brakes while driving slowly until the brakes have regained their normal effectiveness. 60G165S The distance needed to bring any vehicle to a halt increases with the speed of the vehicle. The braking distance needed, for example, at 60 km/h (37 mph) will be approximately 4 times greater than the braking distance needed at 30 km/h (19 mph). Start to brake the vehicle when there is plenty of distance between your vehicle and the stopping point, and slow down gradually. Power-Assisted Brakes Your vehicle has power-assisted brakes. If power assistance is lost due to a stalled engine or other failures, the system is still fully operational on reserve power and you can bring the vehicle to a complete stop by pressing the brake pedal once and holding it down. The reserve power is partly used up when you depress the brake pedal and reduces each time the pedal is pressed. Apply smooth and even pressure to the pedal. Do not pump the pedal. WARNING Even without reserve power in the brake system, you can still stop the vehicle by pressing the brake pedal harder than normally required. However, the stopping distance may be longer. 3-29 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Brake Assist System When you slam the brakes on, the brake assist system judges as an emergency stop and provides more powerful braking for a driver who cannot hold down the brake pedal firmly. NOTE: If you quickly and forcefully depress the brakes, you may hear a clicking sound in the brake pedal. This is normal and indicates that the brake assist system is activated properly. Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) ABS will help you avoid skidding by electronically controlling braking pressure. It will also help you maintain steering control when braking on slippery surfaces or when braking hard. The ABS works automatically, so you do not need any special braking technique. Just push the brake pedal down without pumping. The ABS will operate whenever it senses that the wheels are locking up. You may feel the brake pedal moves a little while the ABS is operating. WARNING • On some types of loose surfaces (such as gravel, snow-covered roads, etc.) the stopping distance required for an ABS-equipped vehicle may be slightly greater than for a comparable vehicle with a conventional brake system. With a conventional brake system, skidding tires are able to “plow” the gravel or snow layer, shortening the stopping distance. ABS minimizes this resistance effect. Allow for extra stopping distance when driving on loose surfaces. • On regular paved roads, some drivers may be able to obtain slightly shorter stopping distances with conventional brake systems than with ABS. (Continued) WARNING (Continued) • In both of the above conditions, ABS will still offer the advantage of helping you maintain directional control. However, remember that ABS will not compensate for bad road or weather conditions or poor driver judgment. Use good judgment and do not drive faster than conditions will safely allow. EXAMPLE (1) (2) 63J081 (1) ABS warning light (2) Brake system warning light NOTE: The ABS will not work if vehicle speed is under about 9 km/h. 3-30 68PH0-74E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE WARNING • If the ABS warning light (1) on the instrument panel comes on and stays on while driving, there may be a problem with the ABS system. Ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to inspect the ABS system immediately. If the ABS system becomes inoperative, the brake system will function as an ordinary brake system that has no ABS. • If the ABS warning light (1) and the Brake system warning light (2) on the instrument panel simultaneously stays on or comes on when driving, both anti-lock function and rear brake force control function (proportioning valve function) of the ABS system may have failed. If so, the rear wheels may easily skid or the vehicle can even spin in the worst case when braking on a slippery road or when hard braking even on a dry paved road. Ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to inspect the ABS system immediately. Drive carefully, avoiding hard braking as much as possible. How the ABS Works A computer continuously monitors wheel speed. The computer compares the changes in wheel speed when braking. If the wheels slow suddenly, indicating a skidding situation, the computer will change braking pressure several times each second to prevent the wheels from locking. When you start your vehicle or when you accelerate after a hard stop, you may hear a momentary motor or clicking noise as the system resets or checks itself. WARNING The ABS may not work properly if tires or wheels other than those specified in the owner’s manual are used. This is because the ABS works by comparing changes in wheel speed. When replacing tires or wheels, use only the size and type specified in this owner’s manual. 3-31 68PH0-74E DRIVING TIPS DRIVING TIPS Running-in ........................................................................... 4-1 Catalytic Converter ............................................................. 4-1 Improving Fuel Economy ................................................... 4-2 Highway Driving .................................................................. 4-3 Driving on Hills .................................................................... 4-3 Driving on Slippery Roads ................................................. 4-4 Driving on Wet Roads ......................................................... 4-5 Do’s and Dont’s for Safe Driving ........................................ 4-6 Margin for Safety ................................................................. 4-9 4 60G409 68PH0-74E DRIVING TIPS Running-in EXAMPLE Catalytic Converter NOTICE 68PHM4001 WARNING • WEAR YOUR SEAT BELTS AT ALL TIMES. Even though air bags are equipped at the front seating positions, the driver and all passengers should be properly restrained at all times, using the seat belts provided. Refer to the “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” section for instructions on proper use of the seat belts. • Never drive while under the influence of alcohol or other drugs. Alcohol and drugs can seriously impair your ability to drive safely, greatly increasing the risk of injury to yourself and others. You should also avoid driving when you are tired, sick, irritated, or under stress. The future performance and reliability of the engine depends on the care and restraint exercised during its early life. It is especially important to observe the following precautions during the initial 960 km of vehicle operation. • After starting, do not race the engine. Warm it up gradually. • Avoid prolonged vehicle operation at a constant speed. Moving parts will break in better if you vary your speed. • Start off from a stop slowly. Avoid full throttle starts. • Avoid hard braking, especially during the first 320 km of driving. • Do not drive slowly with the transaxle in a high gear. • Drive the vehicle at moderate engine speeds. • Do not tow a trailer. EXAMPLE 80G106 The purpose of the catalytic converter is to minimize the amount of harmful pollutants in your vehicle’s exhaust. Use of leaded fuel in vehicles equipped with catalytic converters is prohibited, because lead deactivates the pollutant-reducing components of the catalyst system. The converter is designed to last the life of the vehicle under normal usage and when unleaded fuel is used. No special maintenance is required on the converter. However, it is very important to keep the engine properly tuned. Engine misfiring, which can result from an improperly tuned engine, may cause overheating of the catalyst. This may result in permanent heat damage to the catalyst and other vehicle components. 4-1 68PH0-74E DRIVING TIPS NOTICE To minimize the possibility of catalyst or other vehicle damage: • Maintain the engine in the proper operating condition. • In the event of an engine malfunction, particularly one involving engine misfire or other apparent loss of performance, have the vehicle serviced promptly. • Do not turn off the engine or interrupt the ignition when the transaxle is in gear and the vehicle is in motion. • Do not try to start the engine by pushing or towing the vehicle, or coasting down a hill. • Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wires disconnected or removed, such as during diagnostic testing. • Do not idle the vehicle for prolonged periods if idling seems rough or there are other malfunctions. • Do not allow the fuel tank to get near the empty level. • Avoid driving your vehicle at excessively high engine speeds, in or around the red zone of the tachometer (if equipped). Improving Fuel Economy EXAMPLE The following instructions will help you improve fuel economy. Avoid excessive idling If you are to wait for more than a minute while you are parked, stop the engine and start it again later. When warming up a cold engine, allow the engine to idle until the temperature gauge pointer comes up to the “C” position (if the idling is not prohibited). In this position, the engine is sufficiently warm for starting off. 54G584S WARNING Be careful where you park and drive; the catalytic converter and other exhaust components can get very hot. As with any vehicle, do not park or operate this vehicle in areas where combustible materials such as dry grass or leaves can come in contact with a hot exhaust system. Avoid sudden acceleration Sudden acceleration starting from rest or while driving will consume fuel unnecessarily and shorten engine life. Start off slowly. Avoid unnecessary stops Avoid unnecessary deceleration and stopping. Try to maintain a slow, steady speed whenever possible. Slowing down and then accelerating again uses more fuel. Keep a steady cruising speed Keep as constant a speed as road and traffic conditions will permit. 4-2 68PH0-74E DRIVING TIPS Highway Driving Keep the air cleaner clean EXAMPLE 60A183S If the air cleaner is clogged with dust, there will be greater intake resistance, resulting in decreased power output and increased fuel consumption. Keep weight to a minimum Heavier the load, more fuel the vehicle consumes. Take out any luggage or cargo when it is not necessary. Keep tire pressures correct Underinflation of the tires can waste fuel due to increased running resistance of the tires. Keep your tires inflated to the correct pressure shown on the label on the driver’s door lock pillar. When driving at high speeds, pay attention to the following: • Stopping distance progressively increases with vehicle speed. Apply the brakes far enough ahead of the stopping point to allow for the extra stopping distance. • On rainy days, hydroplaning can occur. Hydroplaning is the loss of direct contact between the road surface and the vehicle’s tires due to a water film forming between them. Steering or braking the vehicle while hydroplaning can be very difficult, and loss of control can occur. Keep speed down when the road surface is wet. • At high speeds, the vehicle may be affected by side winds. Therefore, reduce speed and be prepared for unexpected buffeting, which can occur at the exits of tunnels, when passing by a cut of a hill, or when being overtaken by large vehicles, etc. Driving on Hills EXAMPLE 79MH0401 EXAMPLE 79MS0T401 • When climbing steep hills, the vehicle may begin to slow down and show a lack of power. If this happens, you should shift to a lower gear so that the engine will again be operating in its normal power range. Shift rapidly to prevent the vehicle from losing momentum. 4-3 68PH0-74E DRIVING TIPS • When driving down a hill, the engine should be used for braking by shifting to next lower gear. (Do this with either a CVT or a manual transaxle vehicle). Driving on Slippery Roads EXAMPLE WARNING Try not to hold the brake pedal down too long or too often while going down a steep or long hill. This could cause the brakes to overheat, resulting in reduced braking efficiency. Failure to take this precaution could result in loss of vehicle control. While moving uphill/gradient from a stand still condition • Apply the parking brake firmly so that the vehicle does not roll backwards. • Depress the Clutch pedal and Shift the gearshift lever to 1st Select position. • Do not slip the clutch. • When ready to start, press accelerator pedal and slowly release the clutch pedal simultaneously. When the vehicle starts to move, gradually release the parking brake. Tire Chains Tire chains should only be used if they are needed to increase traction or are required by law. Make sure that the chains you use are the correct size for your vehicle’s tires. Also make sure that there is enough clearance between the fenders and the chains as installed on the tires. Install the chains on the front tires tightly, according to the chain manufacturer’s instructions. Retighten the chains after driving about 1.0 km if necessary. With the chains installed, drive slowly. 60G089S Under wet road conditions you should drive at a lower speed than on dry roads due to possible slippage of tires during braking. When driving on icy, snow-covered, or muddy roads, reduce your speed and avoid sudden acceleration, abrupt braking, or sharp steering movements. NOTICE • If you hear the chains hitting against the vehicle body while driving, stop and tighten them. • If your vehicle is equipped with full wheel caps, remove the wheel caps before installing the chains or the wheel caps can be damaged by the chain bands. NOTICE When descending down a hill, NEVER turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position or press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “LOCK” (OFF). Emission control system and CVT (if equipped) damage may result. 4-4 68PH0-74E DRIVING TIPS If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck If your vehicle gets stuck in snow, mud, or sand, follow the directions below: 1) Shift the transaxle back and forth between a forward range (or first gear for manual transaxle) and reverse. This will create a rocking motion which may give you enough momentum to free the vehicle. Press gently on the accelerator to keep wheel spinning to a minimum wheel rpm. Remove your foot from the accelerator while shifting. Do not race the engine. Excessive wheel spin will cause the tires to dig deeper, making it more difficult to free the vehicle. 2) If your vehicle remains stuck after a few minutes of rocking, we recommend you to consult your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop or a roadside assistance service. If a towing service is not available in an emergency, your vehicle may be temporarily towed by a towing cable or chain secured to the towing hook either on the front of the vehicle or on the rear of the vehicle. Refer to “Frame Hooks” in the “OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT” section. WARNING Do not allow anyone to stand near the vehicle when you are rocking it, and do not spin the wheels faster than an indicated 40 km/h on the speedometer. Personal injury and/or vehicle damage may result from spinning the wheels too fast. NOTICE Do not continue rocking the vehicle for more than a few minutes. Prolonged rocking can cause engine overheating or transaxle damage. Driving on Wet Roads NOTICE • When driving on wet roads, avoid driving through large amount of standing water on the road. Large amount of water entering the engine compartment may cause damage to the engine and or electrical components. • If stuck in deep water, do not start the engine. • Water is incompressible substance, water inside engine is harmful to the engine. WARNING In addition to following the driving tips in this section, it is important to observe the following precautions. • Make sure your tires are in good condition and always maintain the specified tire pressure. Refer to “Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section for details. (Continued) 4-5 68PH0-74E DRIVING TIPS WARNING (Continued) • Do not use tires other than those specified by MARUTI SUZUKI. Never use different sizes or types of tires on the front and rear wheels. For information regarding the specified tires, refer to the Tire Information Label located on the driver’s door lock pillar. • Never use oversized tires or special shock absorbers and springs to raise (jack up) your vehicle. This will change the handling characteristics. Oversized tires may also rub against the vehicle body over bumps, causing vehicle damage or tire failure. • After driving through water, test the brakes while driving at a slow speed to see if they have maintained their normal effectiveness. If they are less effective than normal, dry them by repeatedly applying the brakes while driving slowly until the brakes have regained their normal effectiveness. Do’s and Dont’s for Safe Driving EXAMPLE Exercise care in handling your vehicle. Be conscious of not only your own safety but also the safety of others on the road, and thus enjoy the best and most comfortable driving experience. Following are basic rules for safe driving. Read them carefully for good understanding of the content so that you can enjoy safe and pleasant driving in your vehicle. Starting 68PHM4002 1) Adjust the driver’s seat for the proper driving posture. 2) Adjust the rear view mirror so as to obtain the best possible rear view. EXAMPLE 83K-04-008 4-6 68PH0-74E DRIVING TIPS 3) Before moving, look around your vehicle to confirm safety. 4) Don’t accelerate suddenly, since it is dangerous and wastes fuel. 5) When overtaking other vehicles, watch out for oncoming vehicles and carefully ensure safety. General driving 6) Don’t attempt zigzag driving as it will hinder your control over the vehicle and may cause an accident. 7) Avoid reckless high speed driving and try to drive at a safe speed suitable for the road conditions while maintaining a constant speed. 8) The higher the speed, the narrower the driver’s visual range becomes. In such a state, it is difficult to anticipate any hazard and the driver feels fatigued. 1) Be sure to stop before a stop light or stop sign. When moving into an intersection without any traffic lights or signs, drive slowly to confirm safety. 2) Always follow other vehicles at a safe distance in order to prevent a rear-end collision, in case the vehicle ahead makes a sudden stop. EXAMPLE 10)When overtaking or changing lanes while driving at a high speed, keep ample vehicle-to-vehicle distance. Braking EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 83k-04-010 83K-04-009 3) Turn ON the turn signal at least 30 meters before making a turn or changing the lane so as to not be hit. 4) Before entering a corner, decelerate to a safe speed. Don’t apply brakes during cornering, or skidding may occur. 83K-04-012 9) Do not attempt sharp handling during high speed driving. You may lose your control over your vehicle. 1) Use the parking brake when parking your vehicle and shift the gear shift lever into the first gear or reverse gear position for the sake of safety. 2) Don’t use hand-braking unless unavoidable. It causes the vehicle to skid and a collision may occur. It is especially dangerous when the tyres are worn out as they skid more. 4-7 68PH0-74E DRIVING TIPS Night time driving EXAMPLE EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 83K-04-011 Use foot brake in three stages 1. Warn the vehicle behind you 2. Gradually apply the brake. 3. Bring the vehicle to a halt. 3) When driving downhill, try not to apply the brake but use the engine brake effectively. Overuse of the foot-brake may result in reduction of brake effectiveness. Long distance driving 83K-04-014 83K-04-013 1) Drive at lower speeds during the night than in the daytime, as the visual range is restricted at night. 2) Avoid overtaking other vehicles at night. Darkness bothers your sense of speed and hinders your judgment of vehicleto-vehicle distance. 3) Don’t use headlights on high beam unless its use is inevitable. It may cause visual impairment to the driver of the oncoming vehicle or the vehicle ahead of you, which may cause an accident. 4) Always keep the window glasses clean. Don’t operate the windshield wiper when the windshield glass is dry else the wiper blade and glass may get damaged. 1) Be sure to perform safety checks before starting a trip. 2) Take rest at regular intervals to prevent accidents which may occur due to feeling sleepy or tired. 4-8 68PH0-74E DRIVING TIPS Margin for Safety It is important to allow yourself a margin for safety during driving so that you can cope with erroneous or unexpected driving of other drivers. For that, observe the following. • Drive at a safe speed. • Maintain a sufficient distance between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead. • Don’t force yourself to overtake other vehicles. • Don’t accelerate suddenly, steer sharply or stop suddenly. • Keep ample gaps between driving schedules. • Observe traffic rules and regulations. Conclusion A perfect driver does not exist. The endeavour of every motorist should be to strive for perfection. Safety consciousness not only ensures your safety and the safety of other road users, it also helps reduce the wear and tear on your vehicle, lengthens its life, gives better fuel efficiency and ensures a comfortable driving experience. Follow the do’s and dont’s listed, and driving will never be the same again. 4-9 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT 68PM5002 Fuel Filler Cap ..................................................................... 5-1 Engine Hood ........................................................................ 5-2 Sun Visor ............................................................................. 5-4 Interior Light ........................................................................ 5-5 Accessory Socket ............................................................... 5-8 AUX/USB Socket (if equipped) ........................................... 5-9 Assist Grips ......................................................................... 5-9 Glove Box ............................................................................ 5-10 5 Cup Holder and Storage Area ............................................ 5-11 Footrest ................................................................................ 5-13 Floor Mats (if equipped) ..................................................... 5-13 Luggage Compartment Hook ............................................. 5-14 Luggage Compartment Cover ............................................ 5-14 Frame Hooks ....................................................................... 5-15 Heating and Air Conditioning System ............................... 5-16 Manual Heating and Air Conditioning System ................. 5-19 Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning System (Climate Control) ................................................................. 5-24 Radio Antenna ..................................................................... 5-30 Installation of Radio Frequency Transmitters .................. 5-30 Audio System (if equipped) ................................................ 5-31 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Fuel Filler Cap The fuel filler cap is located on the left rear side of the vehicle. The fuel filler door can be unlocked by pulling up the opener lever located on the outboard side of the driver’s seat and locked by simply closing the door. EXAMPLE Close Open EXAMPLE (1) (3) (1) (1) (2) 68PH00502 68PH00501 EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 57L51093 To remove the fuel filler cap: 1) Open the fuel filler door. 2) Remove the cap by turning it counterclockwise. CAUTION Remove the fuel filler cap slowly. The fuel may be under pressure and may spray out, causing injury. NOTE: The cap holder (1) holds the fuel filler cap (2) by hooking the groove (3) when refueling. To reinstall the fuel filler cap: 1) Turn the cap clockwise until you hear several clicks. 2) Close the fuel filler door. WARNING Fuel is extremely flammable. Do not smoke when refueling, and make sure there are no open flames or sparks in the area. 68PH00574 5-1 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT WARNING If you need to replace the fuel cap, use a MARUTI genuine cap. Use of an improper cap can result in a malfunction of the fuel system or emission control system. It may also result in fuel leakage in the event of an accident. Engine Hood EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 68PH00504 68PH00503 To open the engine hood: 1) Pull the hood release handle located on the outboard side of the driver’s side of the instrument panel. This will disengage the engine hood lock halfway. 2) Push the under-hood release lever sideways with your finger, as shown in the illustration. While pushing the lever, lift up the engine hood. CAUTION The release lever can be hot enough to burn your finger right after driving. Touch the lever after it becomes cool enough. NOTICE Make sure that the wiper arms are not raised before you lift up the engine hood to avoid damaging the wiper arms and the engine hood. 5-2 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT EXAMPLE To close the engine hood: 1) Lift the hood up slightly and remove the prop rod from the hole. Put the prop rod back to the holding clip. EXAMPLE WARNING Make sure the hood is fully closed and latched before driving. If it is not, it can fly up unexpectedly during driving, obstructing your view and resulting in an accident. CAUTION To avoid injury, be sure no part of the occupant’s body such as hands or head is in the path of the hood when closing it. 68PH00505 3) While holding the hood, pull the prop rod out from the holding clip, then insert the end of the rod into the designated hole. CAUTION • The prop rod can be hot enough to burn your finger right after driving. Touch the rod after it becomes cool enough. • Insert the end of the rod into the hole securely. If the rod drops off, your body may be caught in the hood. • The rod may drop off when the hood is hit by a wind. Be careful on windy days. NOTICE 68PH00506 2) Lower the hood to about 20 cm above the hood latch, then let it drop down. Make sure the hood is securely latched after closing. Pressing the hood from above may damage the hood. 5-3 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Sun Visor Card holder (if equipped) Type1 You can put a card in the card holder (1) on the back of the sun visor. NOTICE When you park your vehicle outdoors in direct sunlight or in hot weather, do not leave plastic cards in the holder. The heat may distort them. Vanity mirror (if equipped) EXAMPLE (1) EXAMPLE 68PH00507 The sun visors can be pulled down to block glare coming through the windshield, or they can be unhooked and turned to the side to block glare coming through the side window. (3) 68PH00508 Type2 (2) (4) NOTICE When unhooking and hooking a sun visor, be sure to handle it by the hard plastic parts or the sun visor can be damaged. 68PH02501 (3) Vanity mirror (4) Vanity mirror light (if equipped) (1) EXAMPLE 68PH00509 To use the vanity mirror (3) on the back of the sun visor, pull up the mirror cover (2). The vanity mirror light (4) comes on when the mirror cover (2) is opened. (1) Card holder (2) Mirror cover 5-4 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT WARNING • Do not use the mirror while driving your vehicle or could lose control of the vehicle. • When using the vanity mirror, do not move too close to a front air bag location or lean against it. If the front air bag is accidentally inflated, it could hit you hard. Interior Light EXAMPLE EXAMPLE (3) (4) (5) NOTICE If the vanity mirror has the light, do not leave the mirror cover open for a long time, or the battery will discharge. (1) (2) (5) (2) 68PH00511 (1) Glove box light (if equipped) (2) Footwell lights (if equipped) (6) 68PH00512 (3) (4) (5) (6) Front (if equipped) Center Courtesy Lights (if equipped) Luggage compartment (if equipped) 5-5 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Glove Box Light (if equipped) (1) Refer to “Glove Box” in this section. Footwell Lights (if equipped) (2) Front (if equipped) (3) Center (4) EXAMPLE EXAMPLE (c) (b) (a) A footwell light is provided in the leg space in front of each front seat. The light comes on when the door is opened. After closing all doors, the light will remain on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. If you press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “ACC” or “ON” during this time, the light will start to fade out immediately. NOTE: • You can change the footwell lights operation via the information display. Refer to “Information Display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section. • If you leave any door open, the light will automatically be turned off after about 15 minutes to prevent the battery from discharging. 68PH00513 68PH00514 Push the switch to turn on the light and push it again to turn off the light. This light switch has three positions which function as described below: NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with the keyless push start system or the keyless entry system, the light will automatically be turned off to prevent the battery from discharging when the following conditions are simultaneously met: • The ignition switch is in the “LOCK” position, or the ignition mode is “LOCK” (OFF). • The hazard warning lights, the position lights and the headlights are off. • After 15 minutes of the light on. ON (a) The light comes on and stays on regardless of whether the door is open or closed. NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with the keyless push start system or the keyless entry system, the light will automatically be turned off to prevent the battery from discharging when the following conditions are simultaneously met: • The ignition switch is in the “LOCK” position, or the ignition mode is “LOCK” (OFF). • The hazard warning lights, the position lights and the headlights are off. • After 15 minutes of the light on. 5-6 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT DOOR (b) The light comes on when the door is opened. After closing all doors, the light will remain on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. If you insert the key, or press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “ACC” or “ON” during this time, the light will start to fade out immediately. After removing the key from the ignition switch or press the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “LOCK”, the light will turn on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. NOTE: If you leave any door open, the light will automatically be turned off after about 15 minutes to prevent the battery from discharging. OFF (c) The light remains off even when the door is opened. Courtesy Lights (if equipped) (5) EXAMPLE Luggage Compartment (if equipped) (6) EXAMPLE (1) (2) 68PH00515 Each front door has a courtesy light on its inside bottom. It lights automatically when the door is opened. NOTE: If you leave any door open, the light will automatically be turned off after about 15 minutes to prevent the battery from discharging. 68PH00516 When you open the tailgate with the luggage compartment light switch in the “ON” position (1), the light comes on for about 15 minutes. When the luggage compartment light switch is in the “OFF” position (2), the light remains off regardless of whether the tailgate is open or close. 5-7 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Accessory Socket EXAMPLE The accessory socket will work when the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position, or the ignition mode is “ACC” or “ON”. Each socket can be used to provide 12 volt/120 watt/10 ampere power for electrical accessories when used alone. Make sure that the cap remains on the socket when the socket is not in use. Center console EXAMPLE NOTICE 68PH00517 NOTE: The number of doors involved in the lighting operation of the interior light depends on the vehicle specification. If there is a switch (rubber projection) at the door opening as shown, the door is involved in the lighting operation. The tailgate is also involved in this operation even without the rubber projection. 68PH00518 Floor console EXAMPLE • To prevent the fuse from being blown, when using sockets at the same time, do not exceed the total combined power capacity of 12 volt/120 watt/10 ampere. • Use of inappropriate electrical accessories can cause damage to your vehicle’s electrical system. Make sure that any electrical accessories you use are designed to plug into this type of socket. 68PH00519 5-8 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT AUX/USB Socket (if equipped) Assist Grips Coat Hooks EXAMPLE 68PH00520 Connect your portable digital music player, etc. to this socket to enjoy music through the vehicle’s audio system using it as a source. Refer to “Audio System” in this section NOTICE 68PH00521 Assist grips are provided for convenience. NOTICE To avoid damaging the assist grip and the molded headlining, do not hang down the assist grip. 68PH00522 You can hang clothing on the coat hooks. These hooks are not designed for large or heavy items and are located with rear right assist grip. Always close the lid when not in use, since entry of foreign material, dust, water, conductive liquids may damage the audio system or USB device. 5-9 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Glove Box EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 68PH00523 To open the glove box, pull the latch lever. To close it, push the lid until it latches securely. 68PH00524 The glove box light (if equipped) stays on while the lid is open. WARNING Never drive with the glove box lid open. It could cause injury if an accident occurs. 5-10 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Cup Holder and Storage Area Driver’s Pocket (1) WARNING EXAMPLE (1) (3) Do not place any objects which may fall out from the pocket when the vehicle is moving. Failure to take the precaution may result in an object interfering with the pedals and causing a loss of vehicle control or an accident. (7) (4)/(5) (2) (3) (6) (7) 68PM5004 (1) Driver’s pocket (3) Front bottle holder (5) Rear cup holder (if equipped) (7) Rear bottle holder (2) Front cup holders (4) Front armrest with console box (if equipped) (6) Front seat back pocket (if equipped) 5-11 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Front Cup Holders (2) / Rear Cup Holder (if equipped) (5) WARNING Front Bottle Holder (3) / Rear Bottle Holder (7) Always place the bottle with its cap closed in the bottle holder. Front Armrest with Console Box (if equipped) (4) NOTICE Failure to take the precautions listed below could cause personal injury or vehicle damage. To avoid damage to the armrest, do not lean on it or allow a child to sit on it. • Be careful when you are using the cup holders to hold a cup containing hot liquid. Spilling out hot liquid can cause burn injury. • Do not use the bottle holders to hold sharp-edged, hard, or breakable objects. Objects in the bottle holders may be thrown about during a sudden stop or impact, and could cause personal injury. • Be careful not to spill liquid or insert any foreign materials into the moving part of the gearshift lever, or any electrical components. Liquid or foreign materials may damage these parts. Console box Use this stowage for keeping small items. Open the compartment by raising the top lid while keeping the lever (1) up. EXAMPLE ( (1) (1) 61MM0B030 NOTE: Always close the lid after you put something into or take something out of the box. 5-12 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Footrest Front Seat Back Pocket (if equipped) (6) Floor Mats (if equipped) EXAMPLE (1) EXAMPLE 68PH00528 This pocket is provided for holding light and soft things such as gloves, newspapers or magazines. CAUTION Do not put sharp-edged hard or breakable objects in the pocket. If an accident occurs, objects such as bottles, cans, etc. can injure the occupants in the rear seat. 68PH00529 68PH00530 Use the footrest (1) as a support for your left foot. To prevent the driver’s side floor mat from sliding forward and possibly interfering with the operation of the pedals, MARUTI genuine floor mats are recommended. Whenever you put the driver’s side floor mat back in the vehicle after it has been removed, be sure to hook the floor mat grommets to the fasteners and position the floor mat properly in the footwell. When you replace the floor mats in your vehicle with a different type such as allweather floor mats, we highly recommend using MARUTI genuine floor mats for proper fitting. 5-13 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT WARNING Failure to take the following precautions may result in the driver’s side floor mat interfering with the pedals and causing a loss of vehicle control or an accident. • Make sure that the floor mat grommets are hooked to the fasteners. • Never place additional floor mats on top of the existing floor mat. Luggage Compartment Hook EXAMPLE Luggage Compartment Cover EXAMPLE 68PH00531 68PH00532 You can hang the shopping bag or other suitable objects on the hook. This hook is not designed for large or heavy items. Luggage or other cargo placed in the luggage compartment is hidden from view by a luggage compartment cover. NOTICE To avoid breaking the hook, do not hang items heavier than following weight. Shopping hook: 2 kg (4.4 lbs) WARNING Do not carry items on top of the luggage compartment cover, even if they are small and light. Objects on top of the cover could be thrown about in an accident, causing injury, or could obstruct the driver’s rear view. 5-14 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Frame Hooks EXAMPLE Front EXAMPLE (1) EXAMPLE (C) (A) (1) (B) (A) 68PH00533 The towing hook (1) is provided on the front of the vehicle for use in emergency situations only. 61MM0B039 68PH00534 1) Pick up the towing hook (1), jack handle (A) and wheel brace (B) that are stowed in the luggage compartment. 2) Remove the cover (C) by using a jack handle (A) covered with a soft cloth as shown in the illustration. EXAMPLE To install the hook (1), follow the procedure below. (1) 68PH00535 3) Install the towing hook (1) by hand. 5-15 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Rear EXAMPLE EXAMPLE (1) Heating and Air Conditioning System There are two of heating and air conditioning systems as follows: • Manual Heating and Air Conditioning System • Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning System (Climate Control) (B) (2) 68PH00536 4) To tighten the towing hook (1), turn it clockwise by using a wheel brace (B) until the hook (1) is securely installed. WARNING Use extreme caution when you use the towing hook (1). Avoid pulling the vehicle to get out of severe snowy, muddy or sandy conditions, sudden starts or erratic driving maneuvers which would give excessive stress on the towing hook. The towing hook or vehicle body may break and cause serious injury or damage. To remove the towing hook (1), reverse the procedure used to install the towing hook. 68PH00537 The frame hook (2) is provided on the rear of the vehicle. WARNING Use extreme caution when you use the frame hook (2). Avoid towing the vehicle heavier than your vehicle, pulling the vehicle to get out out of severe snowy, muddy or sandy conditions, sudden starts or erratic driving maneuvers which would give excessive stress on the frame hook. The towing hooks or vehicle body may break and cause serious injury or damage. To tow your vehicle on the road or highway, follow the instruction of “Towing” in “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section. 5-16 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Air Outlet (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (1) Windshield defroster outlet Side defroster outlet Side outlet Center outlet Floor outlet (2) (3) (4) (2) (3) (5) (5) EXAMPLE 68PH00538 5-17 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Center outlet Side outlet (1) (1) (2) (1) 68PH00540 68PH00539 Move the knob (1) vertically or horizontally, to adjust the direction of airflow as desired. Move the knob (1) vertically or horizontally, to adjust the direction of airflow as desired. The side outlet opens when you turn the dial (2) upward and closes when you turn it downward. 5-18 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Manual Heating and Air Conditioning System Air flow selector (3) Bi-level (b) (c) Description of Controls (1) (2) (b) (3) (a) (4) (5) 68PH02502 (d) (e) 68PH00542 68PH00544 This is used to select one of the functions described below. Temperature-controlled air comes out of the floor outlets and cooler air comes out of the center and side outlets. When the temperature selector (1) is in the fully COLD position or fully HOT position, however, the air from the floor outlets and the air from the center and side outlets will be the same temperature. Ventilation (a) Temperature selector (1) This is used to select the temperature by turning the selector. Blower speed selector (2) This is used to turn on the blower and to select blower speed by turning the selector. 68PH00543 Temperature-controlled air comes out of the center and side outlets. 5-19 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Heat & defrost (d) Heat (c) Defrost (e) 68PH00545 68PH00546 68PH00547 Temperature-controlled air comes out of the floor outlets and the side outlets, also comes out of the windshield defroster outlets and also comes slightly out of the side defroster outlets. Temperature-controlled air comes out of the floor outlets, the windshield defroster outlets, the side defroster outlets and the side outlets. Temperature-controlled air comes out of the windshield defroster outlets, the side defroster outlets and the side outlets. 5-20 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Air intake selector (4) (f) (g) 68PH00548 This selector is used to select the following modes. Fresh Air (f) When this mode is selected, the indicator light will go off and outside air is used. Recirculated Air (g) When this mode is selected, the indicator light will come on, outside air is shut out and inside air is recirculated. This mode is suitable when driving through dusty or polluted air such as in a tunnel, or when attempting to quickly cool down the interior. “FRESH AIR” and “RECIRCULATED AIR” are switched alternately each time the air intake selector is pushed. NOTE: If you select “RECIRCULATED AIR” for an extended period of time, the air in the vehicle can become contaminated. Therefore, you should occasionally select “FRESH AIR”. Air conditioning switch (5) To turn on the air conditioning system, set the blower speed selector to a position other than off and push in the “A/C” switch. With this “A/C” switch operation, a indicator light will come on when the air conditioning system is on. To turn off the air conditioning system, push the “A/C” switch again. During operation of the air conditioner, you may notice slight changes in engine speed. These changes are normal, the system is designed so that the compressor turns on or off to maintain the desired temperature. Less operation of the compressor results in better fuel economy. System Operating Instructions Natural ventilation Select “VENTILATION” and “FRESH AIR”, the temperature selector to the desired temperature position, and the blower speed selector to off. Fresh air will flow through the vehicle during driving. Forced ventilation The control settings are the same as for natural ventilation except you set the blower speed selector to a position other than off. Normal heating (using outside air) Select “HEAT” and “FRESH AIR”, the temperature selector to the desired temperature position and the blower speed selector to the desired blower speed position. Setting the blower speed selector to a higher blower speed position increases heating efficiency. Quick heating (using recirculated air) The control settings are the same as for normal heating except you select “RECIRCULATED AIR”. If you use this heating method for an extended period of time, the air in the vehicle can become contaminated and the windows can become misty. Therefore, use this method only for quick heating and change to the normal heating method as soon as possible. 5-21 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Head cooled/Feet warmed heating Select “BI-LEVEL” and “FRESH AIR”, the temperature selector to the desired temperature position, and the blower speed selector to the desired blower speed position. Unless the temperature selector is in the fully COLD position or fully HOT position, the air that comes out of the center and side outlets will be cooler than the air that comes out of the floor outlets. Normal cooling Set the air flow selector to “VENTILATION”, the temperature selector to the desired temperature position and the blower speed selector to the desired blower speed position, and turn on the “A/C” switch. Setting the blower speed selector to a higher blower speed position increases cooling efficiency. You can switch the air intake selector to either “FRESH AIR” or “RECIRCULATED AIR” as you desire. Choosing “RECIRCULATED AIR” increases cooling efficiency. Quick cooling (using recirculated air) The control settings are the same as for normal cooling except you select “RECIRCULATED AIR” and the highest blower speed. NOTE: • If you select “RECIRCULATED AIR” for an extended period of time, the air in the vehicle can become contaminated. Therefore, you should occasionally select “FRESH AIR”. • If your vehicle has been left in the sun with the windows closed, it will cool faster if you open the windows briefly while you operate the air conditioner with the air intake selector at “FRESH AIR” and the blower at high speed. Dehumidifying Set the air flow selector to a desired air flow selector position, the temperature selector to the desired temperature position and the blower speed selector to the desired blower speed position. Also select “FRESH AIR” and turn on the “A/C” switch. NOTE: Because the air conditioner dehumidifies the air, turning it on will help keep the windows clear, even when blowing heated air using the “DEFROST” or “HEAT & DEFROST” functions. EXAMPLE 68PH00549 NOTE: If you need maximum defrosting: • select “DEFROST” and “FRESH AIR”, • set the blower speed selector to HIGH, • adjust the temperature selector to the HOT end, • turn on the “A/C” switch, and • adjust the side outlets so the air blows on the side windows. 5-22 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Maintenance If you do not use the air conditioner for a long period, such as during winter, it may not give the best performance when you start using it again. To help maintain optimum performance and durability of your air conditioner, it needs to be run periodically. Operate the air conditioner at least once a month for one minute with the engine idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil and helps protect the internal components. If your air conditioner is equipped with air filters, clean or replace them as specified in the “Maintenance Schedule” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. NOTE: Your vehicle uses the air conditioning refrigerant HFC-134a, commonly called “R-134a”. R-134a replaced R-12 around 1993 for automotive applications. Other refrigerants are available, including recycled R-12, but only R-134a should be used in your vehicle. NOTICE Using the wrong refrigerant may damage your air conditioning system. Use R-134a only. Do not mix or replace the R-134a with other refrigerants. 5-23 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning System (Climate Control) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) Description of Controls (2) (6) (5) (4) (9) (8) Temperature selector Blower speed selector Air intake selector Air flow selector Defrost switch Air conditioning switch “OFF” switch “AUTO” switch Display (1) (7) (3) 68PH00550 5-24 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Temperature selector (1) Air intake selector (3) Blower speed selector (2) (1) (2) (a) (3) (b) 68PH00551 68PH00552 68PH00553 Push the temperature selector (1) to adjust the temperature. Air flows out at a higher rate when you press the upper switch and at a lower rate when you press the lower switch. Push the air intake selector (3) to change between the following modes. If the “AUTO” switch (8) is pushed, the blower speed will vary automatically as the climate control system maintains the selected temperature. If the “AUTO” switch (8) is pushed, the air intake will vary automatically as the climate control system maintains the selected temperature. NOTE: When you select the recirculated air mode, the automatic operation system is deactivated if you push the “AUTO” switch (8). RECIRCULATED AIR (a) When this mode is selected, outside air is shut off and inside air is recirculated. This mode is suitable when driving through an area with polluted air such as a tunnel, or when attempting to quickly cool down the vehicle. 5-25 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT FRESH AIR (b) When this mode is selected, outside air is introduced. “FRESH AIR” and “RECIRCULATED AIR” are selected alternately each time the air intake selector is pushed. If the “AUTO” switch (8) is pushed, the air flow will vary automatically as the climate control system maintains the selected temperature. Bi-level (d) Ventilation (c) NOTE: If you select “RECIRCULATED AIR” for an extended period of time, the air in the vehicle can become contaminated. Therefore, you should occasionally select “FRESH AIR”. 68PH00544 Air flow selector (4) (c) 68PH00543 Temperature-controlled air comes out of the center and side outlets. (d) Temperature-controlled air comes out of the floor outlets and cooler air comes out of the center and side outlets. When the temperature selector (1) is in the fully COLD position or fully HOT position, however, the air from the floor outlets and the air from the center and side outlets will be the same temperature. (e) (4) (f) 68PH00554 Push the air flow selector (4) to change among the following functions. The indication of the selected mode appears on the display. 5-26 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Heat & defrost (f) Heat (e) Defrost switch (5) (5) 68PH00545 68PH00546 68PH00555 Temperature-controlled air comes out of the floor outlets and the side outlets, a small amount of air comes out of the windshield defroster outlets and also comes slightly out of the side defroster outlets. Temperature-controlled air comes out of the floor outlets, the windshield defroster outlets, the side defroster outlets and the side outlets. Push the defrost switch (5) to turn on the defroster. 5-27 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT System Operating Instructions Air conditioning switch (6) Defrost Automatic operation (6) 68PH00547 Temperature-controlled air comes out of the windshield defroster outlets, the side defroster outlets and the side outlets. NOTE: When the defrost switch (5) is pushed to turn on the defroster, the air conditioning system will come on and the “FRESH AIR” mode will be selected automatically. In very cold weather, however, the air conditioning system will not turn on. 68PH00556 The air conditioning switch (6) is used to turn on and off the air conditioning system only when the blower is on. To turn on the air conditioning system, push in the switch and “A/C” will appear on the display. To turn off the air conditioning system, push in the switch again and “A/C” will go off. (6) (8) (7) (1) 68PH00557 You can let the climate control system work automatically. To set the system for fully-automatic operation, follow the procedure below. 1) Start the engine. 2) Push the “AUTO” switch (8). 3) Set the desired temperature by turning the temperature selector (1). The blower speed, air intake and air flow are controlled automatically to maintain the set temperature. However, the air flow is not changed to the “Defrost” position automatically. NOTE: When you select the recirculated air mode, the automatic operation system is deactivated if you push the “AUTO” switch (8). 5-28 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT You can use the air conditioning switch (6) to manually turn the air conditioner on or off according to your preference. When you turn the air conditioning switch off, the climate control system cannot lower the inside temperature below outside temperature. To turn the climate control system off, push the “OFF” switch (7). NOTE: If the “AUTO” on the display blinks, there is a problem in the heating system and/or air conditioning system. You should have the system inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. NOTE: • To find the temperature at which you are most comfortable, start with the 25°C (75°F) setting. • If you turn the temperature selector (1) until “HI” or “LO” appears on the display, the climate control system will operate at maximum heating or cooling and the blower will run at full speed. • To avoid blowing cold air in cold weather or hot air in hot weather, the system will delay turning on the blower until warmed or chilled air is available. • If your vehicle has been left in the sun with the windows closed, it will cool faster if you open the windows briefly. • Even under the automatic operation, you can set individual selectors to the man- ual mode. The manually selected functions are maintained, and the other functions remain under automatic operation. • If the windshield and/or the front door windows are fogged, push the defrost switch (5) to turn on the defroster, or push the air flow selector (4) to change the air flow to the “Heat & defrost” position to defog the windows. • To return the blower speed selector (2), air intake selector (3), and air flow selector (4) to automatic operation, push the “AUTO” switch (8). Manual operation You can manually control the climate control system. Set the selectors to the desired positions. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 68PH00549 (11) (10) 68PH00558 Be careful not to cover the interior temperature sensor (10) located between the steering wheel and the climate control panel, or the solar sensor (11) located at the top of the driver’s side dashboard. These sensors are used by the automatic system to regulate temperature. NOTE: If you need maximum defrosting: • push the defrost switch (5) to turn on the defroster (the air conditioning system will come on and the “FRESH AIR” mode will be selected automatically), • set the blower speed selector to HIGH, • adjust the temperature selector to the “HI” indication on the display, and • adjust the side outlets so the air blows on the side windows. 5-29 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Maintenance If you do not use the air conditioner for a long period, such as during winter, it may not give the best performance when you start using it again. To help maintain optimum performance and durability of your air conditioner, it needs to be run periodically. Operate the air conditioner at least once a month for one minute with the engine idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil and helps protect the internal components. If your air conditioner is equipped with air filters. Clean or replace them as specified in the “Maintenance Schedule” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. Have this job done by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as the lower glove box must be lowered for this job. NOTE: Your vehicle uses the air conditioning refrigerant HFC-134a, commonly called “R-134a”. R-134a replaced R-12 around 1993 for automotive applications. Other refrigerants are available, including recycled R-12, but only R-134a should be used in your vehicle. NOTICE Using the wrong refrigerant may damage your air conditioning system. Use R-134a only. Do not mix or replace the R-134a with other refrigerants. Radio Antenna EXAMPLE Installation of Radio Frequency Transmitters We recommend that you always ask a authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop about frequency band, max output power, antenna position at vehicle and specific conditions for installation and/or use before installing a radio transmitter in your vehicle. Such equipments may cause the electronic control system to malfunction if they are incorrectly installed or they are not suited for the vehicle. 68PH00559 The radio antenna on the roof is removable. To remove the antenna, turn it counterclockwise. To reinstall the antenna, turn it clockwise firmly by hand. NOTICE To avoid damage to the radio antenna: • Remove the antenna when using an automatic car wash. • Remove the antenna when the antenna hits anything such as a low ceiling in a parking garage or putting a car cover over your vehicle. 5-30 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Audio System (if equipped) AM/FM CD PLAYER 68PH00575 NOTE: For vehicle equipped with SMARTPLAY INFOTAINMENT SYSTEM, refer to audio manual available with the vehicle. 5-31 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Safety Information WARNING If you pay extended attention to operating the audio system or viewing the audio system display while driving, an accident can occur. If you set the sound volume too loud, it could prevent you from being aware of road and traffic conditions. • Keep your eyes on the road and your mind on the drive. Avoid paying extended attention to operating the audio system or viewing the audio system display. • Familiarize yourself with the audio system controls and operation of the audio system before driving. • Preset your favorite radio stations before driving so that you can quickly tune to them using the presets. • Set the sound volume to a level that will allow you to continue to be aware of road and traffic conditions while driving. Notes on Discs Precautions • When the inside of the vehicle is very cold and the player is used soon after switching on the heater, condensation may form on the disc or the optical parts of the player and proper playback may not be possible. If condensation forms on the disc, wipe it off with a soft cloth. If condensation forms on the optical parts of the player, do not use the player for about one hour. This will allow the condensation to disappear normally. • Driving on extremely bumpy roads which cause severe vibrations may cause sound to skip. • This unit uses a precision mechanism. Even in the event that trouble arises, never open the case, disassemble the unit, or lubricate the rotating parts. Please bring the unit to an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Cautions on Handling (A) 52D274 This unit has been designed specifically for playback of compact discs bearing mark (A) shown above. No other discs can be played. Removing the disc Proper way to hold the compact disc 52D275 To remove the compact disc from its storage case, press down on the center of the case and lift the disc out, holding it carefully by the edges. Always handle the compact disc by the edges. Never touch the surface. 5-32 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Use of such discs will cause damage or prevent the system from operating properly. 52D348 52D347 To remove fingermarks and dust, use a soft cloth, and wipe in a straight line from the center of the compact disc to the circumference. (B) (C) Never stick labels on the surface of the compact disc or write on the surface with a pencil or pen. (B) 52D349 Do not use any solvents such as commercially available cleaners, anti-static spray, or thinner to clean compact discs. 52D351 Do not expose compact discs to direct sunlight or any heat source. NOTE: • Do not use commercially available CD protection sheets or discs equipped with stabilizers, etc. These may get caught in the internal mechanism and damage the disc. • It may be impossible to play CD-R discs with this unit due to the recording conditions. • CD-RW discs cannot be played with this unit. 52D277 New discs may have some roughness around the edges. The unit may not work or the sound may skip if such discs are used. Use a ball-point pen (B), etc. to remove the roughness (C) from the edges of the disc before inserting it into the unit. 52D350 Do not use compact discs that have large scratches, are misshaped, or cracked, etc. 5-33 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT WARNING This is a class I laser product. Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure. Do not open covers and do not attempt to repair this unit by yourself. Refer servicing to qualified personnel. The Bluetooth® word mark and logo are registered trademarks and are owned by the Bluetooth SIG, Ink. Stop using this unit and a Bluetooth® ready device whenever requested. This unit shares the communication frequency with other private or public wireless communication equipment such as a wireless LAN and other wireless communication radios. You should stop using this unit whenever you are notified that your unit disturbs other wireless communication immediately. 5-34 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Basic Operations Turning power on/off Press the VOL PUSH POWER knob (1). The unit starts in the function mode it was in when the power was turned off last. Adjusting the volume Turn the VOL PUSH POWER knob (1). Turning it clockwise increases the volume; turning it counterclockwise decreases the volume. NOTE: While driving, adjust the volume to an extent that sound and/or noise coming from outside the vehicle can be heard. (2) (1) 68PH00560 (1) VOL PUSH POWER knob (2) TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob 5-35 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Adjusting bass/treble/balance /fader 1) Press the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2). Each time the knob is pressed, sound adjustment will change as follows: Preset-EQ (EQ OFF) Bass adjustment (BASS 0) Treble adjustment (TREBLE 0) Balance adjustment (BALANCE 0) Fader adjustment (FADER 0) AVC adjustment (AVC LEVEL 2) 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to adjust the sound. Adjusting the AVC (Auto volume control) The Auto Volume Control (AVC) function automatically adjusts (increases/ decreases) the sound volume in accordance with vehicle speed. The AVC control is provided with three selectable levels (LEVEL OFF, 1, 2, 3). The range of volume adjustment increases together with the LEVEL number. 1) Press the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) until the AVC adjustment mode is selected. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select the desired AVC adjustment level. (Initial setting: LEVEL 2) Preset-EQ Preset-EQ calls up various sound types in accordance with the listening music type. 1) Press the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) several times until “PRESET-EQ” appears. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2). Each time the knob is turned, preset EQ mode will change as follows: OFF (FLAT) JAZZ ROCK POP CLASSIC HIP-HOP 5-36 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to the Radio Display (A) (B) (3) (1) (4) (2) (5) (7) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) FM button AM button Up button Down button TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob Preset buttons ([1] to [6]) AS button (A) Band (B) Frequency (6) 68PH00561 5-37 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Selecting the FM band Press the FM button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the reception band will change as follows: FM1 FM2 Selecting the AM band Press the AM button (2). Seek tuning Press the seek Up button (3) or the seek Down button (4). The unit stops searching for a station at a frequency where a broadcast station is available. Manual tuning Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (5). The frequency being received is displayed. Preset memory 1) Select the desired station. 2) Hold down a desired button ([1] to [6]) of the Preset buttons (6) to which you want to store the station for 2 seconds or longer. Auto store Hold down the AS button (7) for 2 seconds or longer. Six stations in good reception will automatically be stored to the Preset buttons (6) in order, starting from a station whose frequency is the lowest. NOTE: • Auto store can be released by pressing AS button (7) while auto store is under way. • When the auto store is performed, the station previously stored in the memory at the position is overwritten. • When there are fewer than 6 stations that can be stored even if 1 round of auto store operation is performed, no station will be stored at the remaining Preset buttons (6). • 6 stations can be preset for FM1 and FM2 in common, and 6 stations for AM in auto store mode. Radio Reception Radio reception can be affected by environment, atmospheric conditions, or radio signal’s power and distance from the station. Nearby mountains and buildings may interfere or deflect radio reception, causing poor reception. Poor reception or radio static can also be caused by electric current from overhead wires or high voltage power lines. Auto store mode on/off Press the AS button (7). Each time the button is pressed, the mode is switched as follows: AS mode on AS mode off 5-38 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to a CD Display (A) (1) (2) (B) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) Insertion slot Eject button CD button Up button Down button RPT button RDM button DISP button (A) Track number (B) Play time (8) NOTE: This product does not support 8 cm CD (sometimes called as “mini single CD”, “3inch CD”, “CD3”, etc.). 68PH00562 5-39 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT (A) 52D274 • CDs or CD-ROMs carrying no mark (A) cannot be used. • Some discs recorded in CD-R/CD-RW format may sometimes be impossible to use. 52D291 • A CD is to be inserted with its label side up. • When there is a CD already in the unit, it is impossible to insert another CD without ejecting the CD in the unit. Do not use force to insert a CD into the CD insertion slot. NOTICE NOTICE • Never insert your finger or hand into the CD insertion slot. Never insert foreign objects. • Never insert a CD with glue coming out from adhesive tape or a rental CD label or with a trace indicating that adhesive tape or a rental CD label has been removed. This may cause the CD not to eject or result in a malfunction. If you forcefully try to push an ejected CD inside the unit before auto reloading, the disc surface might be scratched. When reloading a CD, remove it from the unit completely before reloading. Loading a CD Insert a CD in the Insertion slot (1). When a CD is loaded, It begins to play. Ejecting a CD Press the Eject button (2). When the ignition mode is “LOCK”, the CD remained ejected for around 15 seconds or longer will automatically be drawn inside the unit. (Auto reload function) The backup eject function: This function allows you to eject a CD by pressing the Eject button (2) even when the ignition mode is off. Listening to a CD When a CD is inserted, playback will automatically start. When a CD is already inside the unit, press the CD button (3) to start playback. Selecting a track • Press the Up button (4) to listen to the next track. • Press the Down button (5) twice to listen to the previous track. When the Down button (5) is pressed once, the track currently being played will start from the beginning again. Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold down the Up button (4) to fast forward the track. • Hold down the Down button (5) to fast rewind the track. 5-40 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Random playback Press the RDM button (7). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: OFF TRACK RANDOM Display change Press the DISP button (8). Each time the button is pressed, display will change as follows: Play time Disc title Track title • TRACK RANDOM The random indicator “RDM” will light. The tracks in the loaded disc will be played in random order. Repeat playback Press the RPT button (6). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: OFF NOTE: • “NO TITLE” will be displayed when there is no text information in the disc currently being played. • If text data contains more than 16 characters, the “>” mark will appear at the right end. Holding down the DISP button (8) for 1 second or longer can display the next page. TRACK REPEAT • TRACK REPEAT The repeat indicator “RPT” will light. The track currently being played will be played repeatedly. 5-41 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to an MP3/WMA/AAC Disc Display (A) (D) (2) (3) (4) (5) (1) (6) (B) (C) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob Up button Down button RPT button RDM button DISP button (A) (B) (C) (D) Folder number Track number Play time DISC type 68PH00563 5-42 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Selecting a folder Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select a folder. Selecting a track • Press the Up button (2) to listen to the next track. • Press the Down button (3) twice to listen to the previous track. When the Down button (3) is pressed once, the track currently being played will start from the beginning again. Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold down the Up button (2) to fast forward the track. • Hold down the Down button (3) to fast rewind the track. Random playback Press the RDM button (5). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: OFF FOLDER RANDOM ALL RANDOM • FOLDER RANDOM The random indicator “F.RDM” will light. The tracks in the current folder will be played in random order. • ALL RANDOM The random indicator “RDM” will light. The tracks in the loaded disc will be played in random order. Repeat playback Press the RPT button (4). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: OFF FILE REPEAT FOLDER REPEAT • FILE REPEAT The repeat indicator “RPT” will light. The track currently being played will be played repeatedly. • FOLDER REPEAT The repeat indicator “F.RPT” will light. All tracks in the currently selected folder will be played repeatedly. 5-43 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Display change Press the DISP button (6). Each time the button is pressed, display will change as follows: Play time Folder name File name Album name (MP3, AAC only) Track title Artist name NOTE: • “NO TITLE” will be displayed when there is no text information in the disc currently being played. • If text data contains more than 16 characters, the “>” mark will appear at the right end. Holding down the DISP button (6) for 1 second or longer can display the next page. Notes on MP3/WMA/AAC What is MP3? • MP3 (MPEG audio layer3) is an audio compression format that has become the standard format among PC users. Its merit is that the original audio data is compressed to approximately 1/10 and high sound quality is maintained. This means that it is possible to store the data of approximately 10 music CDs on a single CD-R/RW disc, which in turn makes it possible to play music for a long time without having to change the disc. What is WMA? • An abbreviation of “Windows Media Audio,” WMA is an audio compression format developed by Microsoft. • WMA files for which the DRM (Digital Rights Management) function is ON cannot be played. • Windows MediaTM and the Windows® logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries. What is AAC? • An abbreviation of “Advanced Audio Coding,” AAC is an audio compression format used by MPEG2 and MPEG4. Points to remember when making MP3/ WMA/AAC files Common • High bit rate and high sampling frequency are recommended for high quality sounds. • Selecting VBR (Variable Bit Rate) is not recommended. Selecting VBR may cause display of incorrect playing time and jumpiness of playback. • Playback sound quality varies depending on the encoding environment. For details, refer to the user manual of the encoding software and the writing software in use. NOTICE Never assign the “.mp3”, “.wma”, or “.m4a” file name extension to a file if it is not in the MP3/WMA/AAC format file. Failure to observe this may result in damage to the speaker due to noise production. Recording MP3/WMA/AAC files on a CD media • It is recommended not to write both CDDA files and MP3/WMA/AAC files on a disc. • If both CD-DA files and MP3/WMA/AAC files are on the same disc, tracks may not be played in the correct order or some tracks may not be played at all. 5-44 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT • When storing both MP3 data and WMA data on the same disc, sort and place them in different folders. • Do not write files other than MP3/WMA/ AAC files and unnecessary folders on a disc. • MP3/WMA/AAC files should be named to meet the standards and the file system specifications as shown below. • The file extension “.mp3”, “.wma” or “.m4a” should be assigned to files based on their format independently. • You may encounter a trouble in playing MP3/WMA/AAC files or displaying information of MP3/WMA/AAC files depending on the writing software or CD recorder in use. • This unit does not have a play list function. • It is recommended to write discs in Discat-Once mode even though Multi-session mode is supported. WMA (Ver. 7, Ver. 8, Ver. 9*) • Bit rate: CBR 32 k - 320 kbps • Sampling frequency: 32 k/44.1 k/48 kHz * WMA 9 Professional/LossLess/Voice are not supported. AAC* • Bit rate: ABR 16 k - 320 kbps • Sampling frequency: 32 k/44.1 k/48 kHz * Apple Lossless is not supported. Supported file systems ISO 9660 Level 1/Level 2, Joliet, Romeo Maximum number of files/folders • Maximum number of files: 512 • Maximum number of files in a folder: 255 • Maximum depth of tree structure: 8 • Maximum number of folders: 255 (Root folder is included.) Compression formats MP3 • Bit rate: MPEG1 Audio Layer III: 32 k - 320 kbps MPEG2 Audio Layer III: 8 k - 160 kbps MPEG2.5 Audio Layer III: 8 k - 160 kbps • Sampling frequency: MPEG1 Audio Layer III: 32 k/44.1 k/ 48 kHz MPEG2 Audio Layer III: 16 k/22.05 k/ 24 kHz MPEG2.5 Audio Layer III: 8 k/11.025 k/ 12 kHz 5-45 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to files stored in a USB device Display (A) (D) (3) (4) (1) (5) (6) (2) (7) (B) (C) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) MEDIA button TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob Up button Down button RPT button RDM button DISP button (A) (B) (C) (D) Folder number Track number Play time File type NOTICE 68PH00560 Do not connect any USB device other than a USB memory or a USB audio player. Do not connect multiple USB devices to the USB connector using a USB hub, etc. Supplying power to multiple USB devices from the connector could cause overheating and smoking. 5-46 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Selecting a USB device mode Press the MEDIA button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: USB (iPod®) (if equipped) Bluetooth® Random playback Press the RDM button (6). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: OFF FOLDER RANDOM ALL RANDOM audio (if equipped) • FOLDER REPEAT The repeat indicator “F.RPT” will light. All the tracks in the folder currently selected will be played repeatedly. Display change Press the DISP button (7). Each time the button is pressed, display will change as follows: AUX (if equipped) Selecting a folder Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select the desired folder. Selecting a track • Press the Up button (3) to listen to the next track. • Press the Down button (4) twice to listen to the previous track. When the Down button (4) is pressed once, the track currently being played will start from the beginning again. Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold down the Up button (3) to fast forward the track. • Hold down the Down button (4) to fast rewind the track. • FOLDER RANDOM The random indicator “F.RDM” will light. The tracks in the currently selected folder will be played in random order. • ALL RANDOM The random indicator “RDM” will light. The tracks in the connected USB device will be played in random order. Repeat playback Press the RPT button (5). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: OFF FILE REPEAT FOLDER REPEAT • FILE REPEAT The repeat indicator “RPT” will light. The track currently being played will be played repeatedly. Play time Folder name File name Album name (MP3, AAC only) Track title Artist name NOTE: • “NO TITLE” will be displayed when there is no text information in the disc currently being played. • If text data contains more than 16 characters, the “>” mark will appear at the right end. Holding down the DISP button (7) for 1 second or longer can display the next page. 5-47 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Notes on USB device Compatible USB devices • USB Mass Storage Class For details as to whether your USB memory/USB Audio is compatible with USB Mass Storage Class, please contact the USB memory/USB Audio manufacturer. • USB Standard Compatibility 1.1/2.0 Full Speed • File System FAT12/16/32, VFAT • Maximum current less than 1.0 A • If devices such as USB hub, extension cable are connected to the audio system, it may not be recognized. In such case connect the USB device directly to the audio system. • Devices such as MP3 player/Mobile phone/digital camera may not be recognized by the audio system for playing music. USB device connection • When connecting a USB device, make sure that the connector is pushed all the way into the port. • Do not leave the USB device for long periods of time in places inside the vehicle where the temperature can rise too high. • Back up any important data beforehand. We cannot accept responsibility for any lost data. • It is recommended not to connect a USB device that contains data files other than MP3/WMA/AAC format. Recording MP3/WMA/AAC files on a USB device • Playback or display may not be possible depending on the type of USB device in use or the condition of the recording. • Depending on the connected USB memory, the files may be played in different order from the order that the files were stored. Maximum number of files/folders • Maximum number of files: 2500 • Maximum number of files in a folder: 255 • Maximum depth of tree structure: 8 • Maximum number of folders: 255 (Root folder is included.) Compression formats MP3 • Bit rate: MPEG1 Audio Layer III: 32 k - 320 kbps MPEG2 Audio Layer III: 8 k - 160 kbps MPEG2.5 Audio Layer III: 8 k - 160 kbps • Sampling frequency: MPEG1 Audio Layer III: 32 k/44.1 k/48 kHz MPEG2 Audio Layer III: 16 k/22.05 k/24 kHz MPEG2.5 Audio Layer III: 8 k/11.025 k/12 kHz WMA (Ver. 7, Ver. 8, Ver. 9*) • Bit rate: CBR 32 k - 320 kbps • Sampling frequency: 32 k/44.1 k/48 kHz * WMA 9 Professional/LossLess/Voice are not supported. AAC* • Bit rate: ABR 16 k - 320 kbps • Sampling frequency: 32 k/44.1 k/48 kHz * Apple Lossless is not supported. 5-48 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to an iPod® Display (A) (B) (3) (4) (5) (1) (7) (6) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (C) MEDIA button TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob Up button Down button RPT button RDM button DISP button Preset buttons ([1] to [6]) (A) Track title (B) Track number (C) Play time (2) (8) 68PH00565 5-49 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Selecting an iPod® mode Press the MEDIA button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: USB (iPod®) (if equipped) Random playback Press the RDM button (6). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: OFF SONG RANDOM ALBUM RANDOM Bluetooth® audio (if equipped) Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold down the Up button (3) to fast forward the track. • Hold down the Down button (4) to fast rewind the track. Playlist name / Track title (Playlist mode only) Artist name / Track title AUX (if equipped) Selecting a track • Press the Up button (3) to listen to the next track. • Press the Down button (4) twice to listen to the previous track. When the Down button (4) is pressed once, the track currently being played will start from the beginning again. Display change Press the DISP button (7). Each time the button is pressed, display will change as follows: • SONG RANDOM The random indicator “RDM” will light. The tracks in the iPod® will be played in random order. • ALBUM RANDOM The random indicator “F.RDM” will light. The albums in the iPod® will be played in random order. Repeat playback Press the RPT button (5). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: OFF Album name / Track title Track title / Play time NOTE: If text data contains more than 16 characters, the “>” mark will appear at the right end. Holding down the DISP button (7) for 1 second or longer can display the next page. SONG REPEAT • SONG REPEAT The repeat indicator “RPT” will light. The track currently being played will be played repeatedly. 5-50 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Playing Mode selection 1) Press the button numbered [1] of the Preset buttons (8) for 1 second or longer. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2). Each time the knob is turned, the mode will change as follows: PLAYLIST ARTIST ALBUM SONGS GENRE 3) Press the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select the desired mode. NOTE: • When the button numbered [1] of the Preset buttons (8) is pressed, the previous mode will be displayed. Notes on iPod® ® Supported iPod • iPod® touch (5th generation) • iPod® touch (4th generation) • iPod® touch (3rd generation) • iPod® touch (2nd generation) • iPod® touch (1st generation) • iPod® classic • iPod® nano (7th generation) • iPod® nano (6th generation) • iPod® nano (5th generation) • iPod® nano (4th generation) • iPod® nano (3rd generation) • iPod® nano (2nd generation) • iPod® nano (1st generation) • iPhone® 5S • iPhone® 5C • iPhone® 5 • iPhone® 4S • iPhone® 4 • iPhone® 3GS • iPhone® 3G • iPhone® * Some functions may not be available depending on the model of iPod®. * iPod® is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. * iPhone® is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. * Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance with safety and regulatory standards. iPod® connection • Make sure to detach the iPod® after pressing the engine switch to change the ignition mode to LOCK. The iPod® may not be shut down when it is being connected and may result in battery depletion. • Please do not connect iPod® accessories such as an iPod® remote control or headphones while connecting the iPod® with the unit. The unit may not operate correctly. 5-51 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT AUX Function AUX connection To listen to auxiliary audio sources (sold separately) through the unit, follow the instruction below. 1) Connect the auxiliary audio source to the AUX/USB socket (separately attached) with an AUX cable. 2) Press the MEDIA button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: USB (iPod®) (if equipped) Bluetooth® audio (if equipped) (1) AUX (if equipped) CAUTION 68PH00566 (1) MEDIA button • Before connection, mute the unit, and also keep the volume of the auxiliary audio source within a range that will not cause distortion. • When the audio source is turned off, noise may be emitted. Be sure to turn off the unit or switch to another mode before turning off the audio source. 5-52 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT NOTE: • Please consult your place of purchase for details about whether a given auxiliary audio source can be connected and the proper auxiliary cord to use. • The volume and tone controls of the auxiliary audio source can be adjusted on the unit. • In AUX mode, the volume setting is different from another mode. 5-53 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Bluetooth® Hands-Free (if equipped) Steering switch (6) Bluetooth (7) (8) (5) 68PH00568 (4) (1) (2) (9) (3) (10) 68PH00567 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob VOL PUSH POWER knob Preset buttons Back button Bluetooth® setup button (on control panel) 68PH00569 (6) Bluetooth® setup button (on steering wheel) (7) Off Hook button (8) On Hook button (9) MUTE switch (10) VOL switch 5-54 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Phone registration To use the hands-free function with this unit, it is required to register the phone in advance. NOTE: • Up to 5 phones can be registered. • To set up a new phone, disconnect the audio player from the unit. Connect the audio player again after phone setup is completed if necessary. • When failed to establish the pairing within 120 seconds, the connecting operation will be canceled. Please try again or refer to the manual of the phone in use for how to establish the pairing with the phone. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Pairing”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Select “MY CAR” from the Bluetooth® menu of the phone and establish the pairing. Refer to the manual of the phone in use for further information. 5) Enter the Passkey displayed on the unit to the phone. 6) When the pairing with the phone is established, automatic transfer of the phonebook and the call history becomes selectable. The automatic transfer starts with “Yes” and it does not with “No”. 7) Press the On Hook button (8). NOTE: • When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. • When additionally registering a phone, operate the same step from 1). Receiving a call Press the Off Hook button (7) to receive a call. Ending a call Press the On Hook button (8) to end a call. Rejecting a call (only for supported models) Press the On Hook button (8) to reject a incoming call. Mute of Hands-free Microphone Press the MUTE switch (9) to mute the microphone. To cancel the mute, press the MUTE switch (9) again. Adjusting the listening volume • Turn the VOL PUSH POWER knob (2) during a call. Turning it clockwise increases the volume; turning it counterclockwise decreases the volume. • Press the VOL switch (10) during a call. Pressing “+” of the switch increases the volume, pressing “-” of the switch decreases the volume. Adjusting the ring volume • Turn the VOL PUSH POWER knob (2) while a call coming in. Turning it clockwise increases the volume; turning it counterclockwise decreases the volume. • Press the VOL switch (10) during a call. Pressing “+” of the switch increases the volume, pressing “-” of the switch decreases the volume. Adjusting the call or ringtone volume Follow the instructions below to adjust the call or ringtone volume. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5-55 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Sound Setting”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Call Volume” or “Ringtone Volume”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. The current call or ringtone volume will be displayed. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select desired call or ringtone volume, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. Dialing using Missed/Incoming/ Outgoing Calls Follow the instructions below to dial to the last dialed number again. NOTE: Up to 30 phone numbers of the latest calls can be stored. (30 calls including missed, received and dialed call) 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “All Calls”, “Missed Calls”, “Incoming Calls” or “Outgoing Calls”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. To dial from the dialed history or the received history, select “All Calls”, “Missed Calls”, “Incoming Calls” or “Outgoing Calls” respectively. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select the desired number, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Dial”, and press the knob (1) or the Off Hook button (7) to dial to the selected number. NOTE: • When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. • Pressing “Confirm” after selecting “Add Speed Dial” can register the selected number in the speed dial. • Pressing “Confirm” after selecting “Delete” can delete the selected number from the call history. Deletion of call history Follow the instructions below to delete a missed/incoming/outgoing call history. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Phonebook”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Delete History”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Missed Calls”, “Incoming Calls”, or “Outgoing Calls”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 6) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select a number to 5-56 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT be deleted or “ALL”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 7) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Delete?” or “Delete All?”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 8) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Confirm”, and press the knob (1) to complete the deletion. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. Registration in Phonebook Registration of numbers in the phonebook. Follow the instructions below to register phone numbers in the Phonebook of the unit. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Phonebook”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Add Con- tacts”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Overwrite All” or “Add One Contact”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. The “Rest of Memory XXXX: Ok?” will be displayed. 6) Press or turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Confirm”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 7) Transfer contacts from the phone. When the registration is completed, the “Setup Phonebook” will be displayed. tory”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Overwrite call History”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Confirm”, and press the knob (1) to transfer the call history from the phone. NOTE: • When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. • Up to 1000 numbers can be registered in Phonebook. Automatic transfer of phonebook/call history You can select whether or not the device transfers the phonebook and the call history automatically when the phone is registered. Follow the instructions below to select. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “A.Transfer”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. Transfer of call history (Call History) Follow the instructions below to transfer call history of the registered phone. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Call His- NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. 5-57 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT 4) Pressing the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) switches between “A.transfer On” and “A.transfer Off”. NOTE: Selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4) stores displayed setting and the previous menu is displayed. Making a call by Phonebook Follow the instructions below to dial a number registered in Phonebook. 1) Press the Off Hook button (7). The Bluetooth® phonebook menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Phonebook”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select the initial of the name you would like to make a call, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. The registered numbers will be displayed in sequence. If names have been registered together with numbers, the names will be displayed. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Dial”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Press the Off Hook button (7). The displayed number or the contact registered with the displayed name will be dialed. NOTE: The system can only access the contacts that are stored in the phone memory. Deletion of registered data (Delete Entry) Follow the instructions below to delete a number registered in Phonebook. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Phonebook”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Delete Contacts”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select a contact to be deleted, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 6) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Delete?”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 7) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Confirm”, and press the knob (1) to complete the deletion. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. Registration in speed dial Follow the instructions below to assign a number to one of the Preset buttons to use as the speed dial. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Phonebook”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Add Speed Dial”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select a contact to be assigned, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 6) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Choose 5-58 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Preset”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 7) Press one of the Preset buttons (3) to which the selected contact is to be assigned. If a contact is already assigned to the selected button, a confirmation message will be displayed. Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Overwrite”, and press the knob (1) to complete the selection. 8) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Confirm”, and press the knob (1) to complete the assignment. When the assignment is completed, the “Setup Phonebook” will be displayed. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. Registration in speed dial (Alternate Method) 1) Press the Off Hook button (7). The Bluetooth® phonebook menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “All Calls”, ”Missed Call” or “Outgoing Call”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. To select a contact / number to be assigned from the dialed history or the received history, select “All Calls” 3) 4) 5) 6) ,“Missed Call”, “Incoming Calls “or “Outgoing Calls” respectively. Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select desired contact/number, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Add to speed dials”, and press the knob (1) to assign to the selected contact/number. Press one of the Preset buttons (3) to which the selected contact is to be assigned. If a number is already assigned to the selected button, a confirmation message will be displayed. Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Overwrite?”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Confirm”, and press the knob (1) to complete the assignment. One-touch call (Speed dial) Follow the instructions below to dial the number assigned to each of the Preset buttons (3). 1) Press the Off Hook button (7). The Bluetooth® phonebook menu will be displayed. Pressing one of the Preset buttons (3) can skip step 2) and the 1st line of step 3). 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Speed Dials”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Press one of the Preset buttons (3). The assigned number/contact will be displayed. When no number is assigned, “No Entry” is displayed. 4) Press the Off Hook button (7). The selected number will be dialed. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. 5-59 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Deletion of speed dial (Del Speed Dial) To delete a number assigned for the speed dial, follow the instructions below. 1) Press the Off Hook button (7). The Bluetooth® phonebook menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Speed Dials”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Press one of the Preset buttons (3) to which the number to be deleted is assigned. “No Entry” appears if the number is not registered. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Delete”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Del Speed Dial”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 6) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Confirm”, and press the knob (1) to complete the deletion. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. Display of device data (Device Name) Follow the instructions below to display the BD (Bluetooth® Device) address and device name. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Bluetooth Info”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Device Name” or “Device Address”, and press the knob (1) to display the device name or the BD (Bluetooth® Device) address. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. Reset to the factory defaults Follow the instructions below to reset all the settings to the factory defaults. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Initialize”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “All Initialize”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Confirm”, and press the knob (1) to start the reset. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. 5-60 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Selection of phone (Select Phone) Follow the instructions below to select a phone to be paired with from the registered phones. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “List Phone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select a phone to be paired with, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Select”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. NOTE: • When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. • The Bluetooth® ready audio device will be disconnected when the phone is selected. List of phones (List Phones) Follow the instructions below to display the names of the registered phones in sequence. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “List Phone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. The names of the registered phones are displayed in sequence. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. Passkey setting (Set Passkey) Follow the instructions below to set the security number (Passkey). 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Passkey”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “New Passkey”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Press or turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Confirm”. 6) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select a number for the first digit, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. Select and determine numbers for the second, third and fourth digits in order in the same manner. When not entering up to the eighth digit, enter blanks for the successive digits. 7) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to determine the passkey setting. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. 5-61 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Deletion of phone information (Delete Phone) Follow the instructions below to delete the registered information of the phone. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “List Phone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select a phone to be deleted, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Delete Phone”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 6) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Delete?”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 7) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Confirm”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. BT function on/off (BT Power) Follow the instructions below to turn on/off the Bluetooth® function. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5) or (6). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “BT Power”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection. 4) Press the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (1) to select “BT Power On” or “BT Power Off”. NOTE: • When the BT function is turned off, the connection between this unit and the registered phone in use will be disconnected. • When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (4), the previous menu will be displayed. 5-62 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Bluetooth® audio (if equipped) Steering switch (8) Bluetooth (3) (4) (7) (1) (5) (6) 68PH00571 Display (A) (2) (B) 68PH00570 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) MEDIA button TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob Up button Down button DISP button Back button Bluetooth® setup button (on control panel) (8) Bluetooth® setup button (on steering wheel) (A) Track number (B) Play time 5-63 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Registration of audio devices To use Bluetooth® ready audio devices with this unit, it is required to register the devices. NOTE: • To set up a new audio player, disconnect the phone from the unit. Connect the phone after audio player setup is completed if necessary. • When failed to establish the connection within 120 seconds, the connecting operation will be canceled. Please try again or refer to the audio player manual for assistance with the pairing process. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (7) or (8). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Pairing”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 4) Select “My Car” from the Bluetooth® menu of the audio player and establish the pairing. Refer to the manual of the audio player in use for further information. 5) Enter the Passkey displayed on the unit to the audio player. NOTE: • When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (6), the previous menu will be displayed. • When additionally registering audio devices, operate the same step from 1). Bluetooth® Selecting the audio mode Press the MEDIA button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: USB (iPod®) (if equipped) Bluetooth® audio (if equipped) AUX (if equipped) Selecting a group (only for supported models) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select a group. Selecting a track • Press the Up button (3) to listen to the next track. • Press the Down button (4) twice to listen to the previous track. When the Down button (4) is pressed once, the track currently being played will start from the beginning again. Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold down the Up button (3) to fast forward the track. • Hold down the Down button (4) to fast rewind the track. NOTE: Some functions may not be available depending on Bluetooth® audio. Display change Press the DISP button (5). Each time the button is pressed, display will change as follows: Play time Track name Artist name Album name NOTE: If text data contains more than 16 characters, the “>” mark will appear at the right end. Holding down the DISP button (5) for 1 second or longer can display the next page. 5-64 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Selection of audio device (Select Audio) Follow the instructions below to select an audio device to be paired with from the registered audio devices. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (7) or (8). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “List Audio”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select an audio device to be used, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Select”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 6) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Confirm”, and press the knob (2) to complete the pairing. NOTE: • When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (6), the previous menu will be displayed. • The phone will be disconnected when the Bluetooth® ready audio device is selected. List of audio devices (List Audio) Follow the instructions below to display the names of the registered audio devices in sequence. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (7) or (8). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “List Audio”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. The names of registered audio devices will be displayed in sequence. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (6), the previous menu will be displayed. Passkey setting (Set Passkey) Follow the instructions below to set the security number (Passkey). 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (7) or (8). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Passkey”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “New Passkey”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 5) Press or turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Confirm”. 6) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select a number for the first digit, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. Select and determine numbers for the second, third and fourth digits in order in the same manner. When not entering up to the eighth digit, enter blanks for the successive digits. 7) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to determine the passkey setting. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (6), the previous menu will be displayed. 5-65 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Deletion of audio device information (Delete Audio) Follow the instructions below to delete the registered information of audio device. 1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (7) or (8). The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed. 2) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 3) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “List Audio”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 4) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select an audio device to be deleted, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 5) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Delete”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 6) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Delete?”, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection. 7) Turn the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (2) to select “Confirm”, and press the knob (2) to complete the deletion. NOTE: When selecting “Go Back” or pressing the back button (6), the previous menu will be displayed. Disclaimer for Bluetooth® function • Depending on the mobile phone models, some phones may not be compatible fully or partially (some function may be restricted). • Connectivity or voice quality may get affected depending on circumstances. • After the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the audio system takes few seconds to detect and connect to the Bluetooth® device (if already paired). Remote Audio Controls (if equipped) Controlling of basic functions of the audio system is available using the switches on the steering wheel. (2) (1) (3) (4) 68PH00572 5-66 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT < < < CD Bluetooth® audio (if equipped) AUX (if equipped) AM (Radio) < (if equipped) Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • To fast forward, press “ ” of the switch (4) for 1 second or longer. • To fast rewind, press “ ” of the switch (4) for 1 second or longer. < FM2 (Radio) USB Selecting the track (CD, USB (iPod®), Bluetooth® audio mode) • To skip to the next track, press “ ” of the switch (4) only for a moment. • To skip to the previous track, press “ ” of the switch (4) twice only for a moment. When the switch (4) is pushed down once only for a moment, the track currently being played will start from the beginning again. < FM1 (Radio) (iPod®) < Selecting the mode Press the switch (3). Each time the button is pressed, the mode will change as follows: Selecting the radio station (FM1, FM2, AM mode) • To select the next preset station, press “ ” of the switch (4) only for a moment. • To select the previous preset station, press “ ” of the switch (4) only for a moment. • To scan a higher frequency radio station, press “ ” of the switch (4) for 1 second or longer. • To scan a lower frequency radio station, press “ ” of the switch (4) for 1 second or longer. < Adjusting the volume • To increase the volume, hold down “+” of the VOL switch (1). The volume will keep on being increased until the switch is released. • To decrease the volume, hold down “-” of the VOL switch (1). The volume will keep on being decreased until the switch is released. • To mute the sound, press the switch (2). It is possible to turn on the audio system by pressing the switch (3). 5-67 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Anti-Theft Feature (1) (2) (3) (4) VOL PUSH POWER knob Preset buttons ([1] to [6]) Up button TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (3) (1) (4) (2) 68PH00573 5-68 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT The anti-theft function is intended to discourage thefts, such as that the audio system becomes inoperable when it is installed on other vehicles. This function works by entering a Personal Identification Number (PIN). When the unit is disconnected from its power source, such as when the audio system is removed or the battery is disconnected, the unit will become inoperable until the PIN is reentered. Setting the Anti-Theft Function 1) Press the VOL PUSH POWER knob (1) to power off. 2) Hold down the buttons numbered [1] and [6] of the Preset buttons (2) and press the VOL PUSH POWER knob (1). “SECURITY” will be displayed. 3) Press the Up button (3) and the button numbered [1] of the Preset buttons (2) simultaneously. 4) Enter a 4-digit number to be registered as PIN using the buttons numbered [1] [4] of the Preset buttons (2). 5) Hold down the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (4) for 1 second or longer to set the anti-theft function. NOTE: Take a note of the registered PIN and keep it for the future use. Canceling the anti-theft feature To cancel the anti-theft function, delete the registered PIN. 1) Press the VOL PUSH POWER knob (1) to power off. 2) Hold down the buttons numbered [1] and [6] of the Preset buttons (2) and press the VOL PUSH POWER knob (1). “PIN ENTRY” will be displayed. 3) Press the Up button (3) and the button numbered [1] of the Preset buttons (2) simultaneously. 4) Enter a 4-digit number to be registered as PIN using the buttons numbered [1] [4] of the Preset buttons (2). 5) Hold down the TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (4) for 1 second or longer to delete the registered PIN. The indication “----” will be displayed and the anti-theft function will be canceled. NOTE: To change your PIN, first delete your current PIN, then set a new one. Confirming the Personal Identification Number (PIN) When the main power source is disconnected such as when the battery is replaced, etc, it is required to enter the PIN to make the unit operable again. 1) Set the ignition switch to the “ACC” position. “SECURITY” will be displayed. 2) Press the Up button (3) and the button numbered [1] of the Preset buttons (2) simultaneously. 3) Enter a 4-digit number to be registered as PIN using the buttons numbered [1] [4] of the Preset buttons (2). 4) Hold down TUNE FOLDER PUSH SOUND knob (4) for 1 second or longer. When the PIN same as registered is entered, the power of the audio system will be turned off automatically and it will become operable again. NOTE: If an incorrect PIN is entered, “ERROR” and the total number of incorrect entry attempts will be displayed. If an incorrect PIN is entered 10 times, “HELP” will be displayed and the audio system will become inoperable. 5-69 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Battery Installation WARNING Install a lithium battery (CR2025) with the poles facing the correct direction. • Do not expose the battery to flame. Do not short circuit, disassemble, or heat the battery. • Do not charge the battery. • Use the specified type battery. • Keep the button-shaped battery away from children to prevent accidental swallowing. If the battery is swallowed, contact a doctor immediately. CAUTION Battery replacement timing • When battery power is depleted, the button may not be operable. If the remote controller does not operate, replace the battery and check the operation. • Install the battery with the poles facing the correct direction. • When not in use for a long period of time, or if the battery is dead, remove the battery from the remote controller. Caution on battery • Be sure to follow the instructions to prevent battery leakage, over-heating, ignition or explosion. If battery leakage has occurred, wipe the container first then install a new battery. If the battery solution contacts the skin, wash off with water completely. 68PM5001 5-70 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Caution on Remote Controller • Do not leave the remote controller in an area exposed to direct sunlight, such as on the dashboard or steering wheel. The remote controller may deform because of the heat, (Be especially careful of the dashboard exposed to direct sunlight in the summer, as it will become extremely hot). • When the vehicle is parked in an area exposed to direct sunlight, Ensure the remote controller is placed in an area not exposed to direct sunlight. For example: Glove box. Under direct sunlight, signal reception from the remote controller weakens. If this happens, hold the remote controller close to the signal receptor on the front panel. 5-71 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Remote Controller Common operations POWER button Power ON / OFF TUNE FOLDER UP/DOWN button In Sound Mode Press to adjust the sound.(bass/treble/balance/fader) In Preset-EQ Mode The Preset-EQ setting switches as follows: VOLUME button Press to adjust volume. (including at AUX mode) MUTE button Press to mute the sound. Press it again to cancel the mute. MODE button OFF (FLAT) The mode switches as follows: JAZZ ROCK POP CLASSIC HIP-HOP In AVC Mode The AVC setting switches as follows: OFF LEVEL 1 LEVEL 2 SOUND button While playback, the sound mode switches as follows (including at AUX mode, except while displaying iPod® menu): Preset-EQ BASS FM1 FM2 CD Bluetooth® audio (if equipped) AUX (if equipped) TREBLE USB (iPod®) (if equipped) BALANCE AM FADER AVC LEVEL 3 5-72 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Radio operations SEEK TRACK UP/DOWN button Press to select the radio station. AS button PRESET buttons (1-6) Press to select the desired preset station. Press to return to the last received frequency in the previous auto store mode. Press it for 2 seconds or longer. It selects the stations with the stronger signals and stores them in order. NOTE: When there are fewer than 6 stations that can be stored even if 1 round of auto store operation is performed, no station will be stored at the remaining preset buttons. 5-73 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT CD operations DISP button The display switches as follows: Play time Disc title Track title Press it for 1 second or longer to display the next page. RPT button Press to plays the current track repeatedly. Press it again to cancel. SEEK TRACK UP/DOWN button Press to skip to the next/previous track. Press it for 1 second or longer to fast-forward/ fast-rewind the track. RDM button Press to play the current track randomly. Press it again to cancel. 5-74 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT MP3/WMA/AAC Disc operations DISP button The display switches as follows: Play time Folder name File name Album name (MP3, AAC only) Track title Artist name SEEK TRACK UP/DOWN button Press to skip to the next/previous track. Press it for 1 second or longer to fast-forward/fastrewind the track. Press it for 1 second or longer to display the next page. RDM button The random mode switches as follows: RPT button The repeat mode switches as follows: OFF OFF FOLDER RANDOM ALL RANDOM FILE REPEAT FOLDER REPEAT TUNE FOLDER UP/DOWN button Press to skip to the next/previous folder. 5-75 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT USB operations DISP button The display switches as follows: Play time Folder name File name Album name (MP3, AAC only) Track title Artist name SEEK TRACK UP/DOWN button Press to skip to the next/previous file. Press it for 1 second or longer to fast-forward/fastrewind the file. Press it for 1 second or longer to display the next page. RDM button The random mode switches as follows: RPT button The repeat mode switches as follows: OFF OFF FOLDER RANDOM ALL RANDOM FILE REPEAT FOLDER REPEAT TUNE FOLDER UP/DOWN button Press to skip to the next/previous folder. 5-76 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT iPod® operations DISP button The display switches as follows: Playlist name / Track title (Playlist mode only) Artist name / Track title SEEK TRACK UP/DOWN button Press to skip to the next/previous file. Press it for 1 second or longer to fast-forward/fastrewind the file. Album name / Track title Track title / Play time Press it for 1 second or longer to display the next page. RDM button The random mode switches as follows: OFF SONG RANDOM ALBUM RANDOM RPT button Press to play the current track repeatedly. Press it again to cancel. MENU button During playback • Press to display iPod® menu. • Press it for 1 second or longer to display the top menu. While iPod® menu is displayed • Press to display the folder in one layer upper. • Press it for 1 second or longer to display the top menu. ENT button While displaying iPod® menu, press to select the desired item and display the list. When a track is selected from the list, the playback starts. TUNE FOLDER UP/DOWN button While displaying iPod® menu, press to display the next/previous list in the same layer. 5-77 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Troubleshooting When encountered a problem, check and follow the instructions as described below. If the described suggestions do not solve the problem, it is recommended to take the unit to your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Problem Possible cause Possible solution Common Unable to operate The security function is on. When “SECURITY” is displayed, enter the ID. When “HELP” is displayed, contact your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Unable to turn on the power (no sound). (No sound is produced) Fuse is blown. Contact your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Much noise It may not be exactly tuned in to the station. Tune it in exactly to the station. Unable to receive by auto tuning There may be no station emitting signals powerful enough. Pick up a station by manual tuning. The disc is dirty. Wipe the disc with a soft cloth. The disc has a major scratch or is warped. Replace the disc with the one with no scratch and also not warped. Radio CD Sound skips or noise produced 5-78 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Problem Possible cause Possible solution MP3/WMA/AAC No playback The disc contains unsupported formatted data. Check the file format. Sound skips or noise produced Sound skipping may occur when playing VBR (Variable Bit Rate) files. It is not recommended to play VBR files. There is no supported format file to play on this unit. Check the file format. The current consumption of the USB device exceeds 1.0 A. Use an USB device with a current consumption lower than 1.0 A. The distance between this unit and the Bluetooth® ready device is too far, or a metallic object may be located between the Bluetooth® ready device and this unit. Change the location of the Bluetooth® ready device. The Bluetooth® function of the Bluetooth® ready device is off. Refer to the manual of the Bluetooth® ready device. (Some devices have the power saving function that automatically activates after a certain time.) Unable to receive a call. Your current location may be out of service area. Drive your vehicle to the service area of the phone. The voice quality of hands-free is low (Distortion, noise etc.). Another wireless device may be located near the unit. Switch off the wireless device or keep it away from the unit. USB Playback does not start when the USB device is connected. Bluetooth® Pairing failed 5-79 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Error Display Messages Display Possible cause Possible solution CD ERROR 1 The disc cannot be read. Insert the disc with its label side up. Check the disc if it is not warped or is free of flaws. When ERROR 1 does not disappear even when a normal disc is inserted, contact your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. ERROR 3 The player developed an error of an unidentified cause. When the CD is in the unit, press the CD eject button to remove the disc. When the disc cannot be ejected, contact your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. ERROR 1 The USB device is disconnected. Check the connection of the USB device. ERROR 2 Impossible to communicate correctly with the USB device. Unplug the USB device and plug it again. Check the USB device. ERROR 3 Inoperable due to an unidentified cause. Unplug the USB device and plug it again. When ERROR 3 does not disappear, contact your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. ERROR 4 The current consumption of the USB device exceeds 1.0 A. Check the USB device. USB/iPod® 5-80 68PH0-74E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Display Possible cause Possible solution The player developed an error of an unidentified cause. Disconnect the Bluetooth® ready device and connect it again. When ERROR 1 does not disappear, contact your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Connection Failed Failed to establish pairing or connection Try to establish the pairing or connection again. Memory Full Reached the limit for the number of phonebook data in transfer Delete registered data of unnecessary number in phonebook and try to transfer the register phone numbers in the phonebook again. Not Available Inoperable during driving Operate the system after pulling over your car. Bluetooth® ERROR 1 5-81 68PH0-74E VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING Vehicle Loading ................................................................... 6-1 Trailer Towing ...................................................................... 6-1 6 54G215 68PH0-74E VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING Vehicle Loading Your vehicle was designed for specific weight capacities. The weight capacities of your vehicle are indicated by the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) and the Permissible maximum Axle Weight (PAW, front and rear). The GVWR and PAW (front and rear) are listed in the “SPECIFICATIONS” section. GVWR – Maximum permissible overall weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all the occupants, accessories and cargo plus the trailer nose weight if towing a trailer). PAW – (Front and Rear) Maximum permissible weight on an individual axle. Actual weight of the loaded vehicle and actual loads at the front and rear axles can only be determined by weighing the vehicle. Compare these weights to the GVWR and PAW (front and rear). If the gross vehicle weight or the load on either axle exceeds these ratings, you must remove enough weight to bring the load down to the rated capacity. WARNING Never overload your vehicle. The gross vehicle weight (sum of the weights of the vehicle, all the occupants, accessories, cargo plus trailer nose weight if towing a trailer) must never exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR). In addition, never distribute a load so that the weight on either the front or rear axle exceeds the Permissible maximum Axle Weight (PAW). Trailer Towing EXAMPLE 68PHM6001 WARNING Always distribute cargo evenly. To avoid personal injury or damage to your vehicle, always secure cargo to prevent it from shifting if the vehicle moves suddenly. Place heavier objects on the floor and as far forward in the cargo area as possible. Never pile cargo higher than the top of the seat backs. Your vehicle was originally designed to carry people and a normal amount of cargo, not to tow a trailer. MARUTI SUZUKI does not recommend you use your vehicle to tow a trailer. Towing a trailer can adversely affect handling, durability, and fuel economy. 6-1 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE 60G410 Maintenance Schedule ....................................................... 7-2 Periodic Maintenance Schedule ........................................ 7-2 Drive Belt ............................................................................. 7-6 Engine Oil and Filter ........................................................... 7-6 Engine Coolant .................................................................... 7-11 Air Cleaner ........................................................................... 7-13 Spark Plugs ......................................................................... 7-13 Gear Oil ................................................................................ 7-14 Clutch Pedal ........................................................................ 7-15 Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT) Fluid .................. 7-15 Fuel Filter (Diesel engine) .................................................. 7-17 Brakes .................................................................................. 7-17 7 Steering ................................................................................ 7-19 Tires ...................................................................................... 7-19 Battery .................................................................................. 7-23 Fuses .................................................................................... 7-24 Headlight Aiming ................................................................. 7-28 Bulb Replacement ............................................................... 7-28 Wiper Blades ....................................................................... 7-37 Windshield Washer Fluid ................................................... 7-40 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE WARNING 60B128S WARNING You should take extreme care when working on your vehicle to prevent accidental injury. Here are a few precautions that you should be especially careful to observe: • To prevent damage or unintended activation of the air bag system or seat belt pretensioner system, be sure the battery is disconnected and the ignition switch has been in the “LOCK” position or the ignition mode has been “LOCK” (OFF) for at least 90 seconds before performing any electrical service work on your MARUTI SUZUKI. Do not touch air bag system components, seat belt pretensioner system components or wires. The wires are wrapped with yellow tape or yellow tubing, and the couplers are yellow for easy identification. • Do not leave the engine running in garages or other confined areas. (Continued) (Continued) • When the engine is running, keep hands, clothing, tools, and other objects away from the fan and drive belt. Even though the fan may not be moving, it can automatically turn on without warning. • When it is necessary to do service work with the engine running, make sure that the parking brake is set fully and the transaxle is in Neutral (for manual transaxle vehicles) or Park (for CVT vehicles). • Do not touch ignition wires or other ignition system parts when starting the engine or when the engine is running, or you could receive an electric shock. • Be careful not to touch a hot engine, exhaust manifold and pipes, muffler, radiator and water hoses. • Do not allow smoking, sparks, or flames around fuel or the battery. Flammable fumes are present. • Do not get under your vehicle if it is supported only with the portable jack provided in your vehicle. • Be careful not to cause accidental short circuits between the positive and negative battery terminals. (Continued) WARNING (Continued) • Keep used oil, coolant, and other fluids away from children and pets. Dispose of used fluids properly; never pour them on the ground, into sewers, etc. 7-1 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Maintenance Schedule The following table shows the times when you should perform regular maintenance on your vehicle. This table shows in kilometers and months when you should perform inspections, adjustments, lubrication and other services. WARNING MARUTI SUZUKI recommends that maintenance on your Maruti Suzuki vehicle should be performed by MARUTI SUZUKI authorized workshop/Service station. NOTICE Whenever it becomes necessary to replace parts on your vehicle, it is recommended that you use MARUTI genuine replacement parts or their equivalent. Periodic Maintenance Schedule “A” :Adjust “C”: Clean “R”: Replace or Change “I”: Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary “L”: Lubricate “T”: Tighten to Specified Torque “O”: Rotate NOTE: This table includes services as scheduled up to 80,000 km mileage. Beyond 80,000 km, carry out the same services at the same intervals respectively. 7-2 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Interval: This interval should be judged by odometer reading or months, whichever comes first. km (x1000) months FREE INSPECTION PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AT COST 1 5 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 1 6 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 R Engine 1-1. Water pump drive belt (Tension, Wear) - - - I - I - I - 1-2 Engine Coolant (Level, Leakage) l l l R l R l R l R 1-3 Engine oil, engine oil filter and drain plug gasket. - - R R R R R R R R Petrol 1-4 Cooling system hoses and connections (Leakage and Damage) l l l l l l l l l l 1-5 Engine cylinder head bolts - - T - T - T - T - 1-6 Petrol Engine Mounting and Manifold Fixing (Loose Damage) - - I - I - I - I - 1-7 Valve Clearance - - - - I - - I - - 1-8 Exhaust System (Noise, Leakage etc.) - l - l - I - I - l 1-9 Positive Crank Case Ventilation System (Hoses, Connections and Valve) Petrol - l - l - I - I - l 1-10 Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve Diesel - - - - C - - C - - Petrol Ignition 2-1. Ignition wire (Damage, Deterioration) - - - l - l - l - l 2-2. Spark Plug - - - - - R - - - R Petrol Fuel 3-1. Air cleaner filter element Paved-road Dusty Condition Petrol Clean every 5,000 KM. Replace after every 40,000 KM. Diesel Clean every 10,000 KM. Replace after every 40,000 KM Petrol Clean every 2,500 KM or as required. Replace after every 40,000 KM Replace more frequently if dust condition is severe. Diesel 3-2. Fuel tank cap, fuel lines and connections (Leakage and Damage) - l - - - l - - - l 3-3. Fuel Filter (Leakage) Petrol l l l l l R l l l R 3-4. Fuel Filter and Water Draining Diesel I I I R I R I R I R Clutch and Transmission 4-1. Clutch Pedal (Play) Petrol I I I I I I I I I I 4-2. Clutch fluid (level, leakage) Diesel l l l R l R l R l R 4-3. Clutch slipping (Dragging or Excess Damage) l l l l l l l l l l 7-3 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Interval: This interval should be judged by odometer reading km (x1000) or months, whichever comes first. months 4-4. Manual Transmission Oil (Level, Leakage) 4-5. Continuously Variable Transaxle Fluid (Level, Leakage) FREE INSPECTION PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AT COST 1 5 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 1 6 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 Replace at 1,60,000 km or 10 years whichever comes first l l l l l l l l l l - - - - I - - I - - Drive shaft 5-1. Drive shaft noise I I I I I I I I I I 5-2. Drive shaft boot (damage) - l l l l l l l l l BRAKE 6-1. Brake Fluid (Level, Leakage) I I I R I R I R I R 6-2. Brake pedal (pedal - carpet clearance) I I I I I I I I I I 6-3. Parking brake lever and cable (Play, damage) I I I I I I I I I I 6-4. Brake disc and pad (Wear) – I I I I I I I I I 6-5. Brake drum and shoes (Wear) – – I I I I I I I I 6-6. Master cylinder, wheel cylinder, caliper piston (Fluid leakage, boot/seal damage) I I I I I I I I I I 6-7. Brake hoses and pipes (Fluid leakage, damage) I I I I I I I I I I WHEEL 7-1. Tyres (air pressure, abnormal wear, crack and rotation) I I&O I&O I&O I&O I&O I&O I&O I&O I&O 7-2. Wheels (Damage) I I I I I I I I I I 7-3. Front/Rear wheel bearing (Loose, damage) I I I I I I I I I I FRONT / REAR SUSPENSION 8-1. Suspension strut (Oil leakage, damage) I I I I I I I I I I 8-2. Suspension arms / Knuckle support (Loose, damager) – I I I I I I I I I 8-3. Rear spring (Damage) I I I I I I I I I I 8-4. Shock absorbers (Oil leakage, damage) I I I I I I I I I I 8-5. All bolts and nuts (Loose) – T T T T T T T T T 8-6. Suspension arms and torsion rods – I I I I I I I I I 7-4 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Interval: This interval should be judged by odometer reading km (x1000) or months, whichever comes first. months FREE INSPECTION PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AT COST 1 5 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 1 6 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 STEERING 9-1. Steering wheel (Play, loose) I I I I I I I I I I 9-2. All rods and arms (Loose, damage, wear) I I I I I I I I I I ELECTRICAL 10-1. Battery electrolyte (Level, leakage) I I I I I I I I I I 10-2. Wiring harness connection (Loose, damage) – I I I I I I I I I I 10-3. Lighting system (Operation, stains, damage) I I I I I I I I I 10-4. Horn (Operation) I I I I I I I I I I 10-5. System Voltage I I I I I I I I I I 11-1. All chassis bolts and nuts (Tighten) – I T T T T T T T T 11-2. All latches, hinges and locks (Function)) I I&L I&L I&L I&L I&L I&L I&L I&L I&L BODY ROAD TEST 12-1. Operation of Brakes, gear shifting and speedometer I I I I I I I I I I 12-2. Body and chassis noise I I I I I I I I I I AIR CONDITIONER 13-1. Check belt tension I I I I I I I I I I 13-2. Tighten compressor mounting bolt – T T T T T T T T T 13-3. All hose joint (Check, tighten) I I I I I I I I I I 13-4. Check functioning of recirculating flap I I I I I I I I I I 13-5. Clean condenser with low pressure water – C C C C C C C C C 13-6. Check belt for frayed edges I I I I I I I I I I 13-7. Check all mounting bolts I I I I I I I I I I 13-8. Air conditioner filter element (if equipped) I I I I R I I R I I 7-5 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Drive Belt Engine Oil and Filter For Petrol Engine Model K12M Specified Oil WARNING When the engine is running, keep hands, hair, clothing, tools, etc. away from the moving fan and drive belts. Make sure the drive belt tension is correct. If the belt is too loose, insufficient battery charging, engine overheating, poor power steering, poor air conditioning, or excessive belt wear can result. When you press the belt with your thumb midway between the pulleys, there should be a deflection according to the following chart. For Petrol Engine Model Be sure that the engine oil you use comes under the quality classification of SL. Select the appropriate oil viscosity according to the above chart. DEF: 5.6 – 6.8 mm (0.22 – 0.27 in.) SAE 0W-20 is the best choice for good fuel economy, and good starting in cold weather. For Diesel Engine Model GE Be sure that the engine oil you use comes under the quality classification of ACEA A5/B5. Select the appropriate oil viscosity according to the above chart. The belts should also be examined to ensure that they are not damaged. If you need to replace or adjust the belt have it done by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. SAE 5W-30 is the best choice for good fuel economy, and good starting in cold weather. : 100 N (10 kg, 22 lbs) press GE: Generator DEF: Deflection 68PH00701 For Diesel Engine Model The drive belts tension is adjusted automatically. If you need to replace or adjust the belt have it done by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 7-6 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Oil Level Check If the oil level indication is near the lower limit, add enough oil to raise the level to the upper limit. (For Diesel Engine Model) (For Petrol Engine Model) (3) NOTICE (2) (1) Failure to check the oil level regularly could lead to serious engine trouble due to insufficient oil. NOTICE 68PH00703 68PH00702 EXAMPLE Upper Lower (1) MIN (2) MAX (3) Engine oil dipstick (For Diesel Engine Model) Do not top up the oil over the MAX limit. Too much oil causes serious engine trouble. It is important to keep the engine oil at the correct level for proper lubrication of your vehicle’s engine. Check the oil level with the vehicle on a level surface. The oil level indication may be inaccurate if the vehicle is on a slope. The oil level should be checked either before starting the engine or at least 5 minutes after stopping the engine. The handle of the engine oil dipstick is colored yellow for easy identification. 52D084 Pull out the oil dipstick, wipe oil off with a clean cloth, insert the dipstick all the way into the engine, then remove it again. The oil on the stick should be between the upper and lower limits shown on the stick. 7-7 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Refilling Changing Engine Oil and Filter Drain the engine oil while the engine is still warm. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE EXAMPLE Open Close Open Close 68PH00705 68PH00762 Remove the oil filler cap and pour oil slowly through the filler hole to bring the oil level to the upper limit on the dipstick. Be careful not to overfill. Too much oil is almost as bad as too little oil. After refilling, start the engine and allow it to idle for about a minute. Stop the engine, wait about 5 minutes and check the oil level again. 68PH00704 1) Remove the oil filler cap. 2) Place a drain pan under the drain plug. 3) Using a wrench, remove the drain plug and drain out the engine oil. CAUTION The engine oil temperature may be high enough to burn your fingers when the drain plug is loosened. Wait until the drain plug is cool enough to touch with your bare hands. Tightening torque for drain plug Petrol engine : 35 Nm (3.6 kg-m, 25.8 lb-ft) Diesel engine : 20 Nm (2.0 kg-m, 14.8 lb-ft) WARNING New and used oil can be hazardous. Children and pets may be harmed by swallowing new or used oil. Keep new and used oil and used oil filters away from children and pets. Repeated, prolonged contact with used engine oil may cause skin cancer. Brief contact with used oil may irritate skin. (Continued) 7-8 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE WARNING (Continued) To minimize your exposure to used oil, wear a long-sleeve shirt and moisture-proof gloves (such as dishwashing gloves) when changing oil. If oil contacts your skin, wash thoroughly with soap and water. Launder any clothing or rags if wet with oil. Recycle or properly dispose of used oil and filters. Replace the Oil Filter Tightening (viewed from filter top) 1) Using an oil filter wrench, turn the oil filter counterclockwise and remove it. 2) Using a clean rag, wipe off the mounting surface on the engine where the new filter will be seated. 3) Smear a little engine oil around the rubber gasket of the new oil filter. 4) Screw on the new filter by hand until the filter gasket contacts the mounting surface. (For Petrol Engine Model) 54G093 4) Reinstall the drain plug and new gasket. Tighten the plug with a wrench to the specified torque. (1) Oil filter (2) 3/4 turn 68PH00706 (1) Loosen (2) Tighten 7-9 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE For Diesel Engine Model NOTE: Since special procedures and tools are required, it is recommended that you trust this job to your authorized MARUTI SUZUKI dealer. 1) Using a socket or a ring spanner remove oil filter housing cover (3). (1) Tightening torque for oil filter 3/4 turn or Petrol engine : 14 Nm (1.4 kg-m, 10.3 lb-ft) Diesel engine : 25 Nm (2.5 kg-m, 18.5 lb-ft) NOTICE To prevent oil leakage, make sure that the oil filter is tight, but do not over-tighten it. Refill with Oil and Check for Leaks 1) Pour oil through the filler hole and install the filler cap. For the approximate capacity of the oil, refer to the “Capacities” item in the “SPECIFICATIONS” section. 2) Start the engine and look carefully for leaks at the oil filter and drain plug. Run the engine at various speeds for at least 5 minutes. 3) Stop the engine and wait about 5 minutes. Check the oil level again and add oil if necessary. Check for leaks again. NOTICE (3) (2) 61M7001 (1) Loosen (2) Tighten 2) Remove the old oil filter element and replace it with a new oil filter element. 3) Clean the surface of oil filter cap and replace the O-ring. 4) Tighten the oil filter housing cover on the oil filter housing using a socket or ring spanner to the specified torque. • When replacing the oil filter, it is recommended that you use a MARUTI genuine replacement filter. If you use an aftermarket filter, make sure it is of equivalent quality and follow the manufacturer’s instructions. • Oil leaks from around the oil filter or drain plug indicate incorrect installation or gasket damage. If you find any leaks or are not sure that the filter has been properly tightened, have the vehicle inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 7-10 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Engine Coolant Selection of Coolant To maintain optimum performance and durability of your engine, use MARUTI Genuine Coolant or equivalent. This type of coolant is best for your cooling system as it: • Helps maintain proper engine temperature. • Gives proper protection against freezing and boiling. • Gives proper protection against corrosion and rust. Failure to use the proper coolant can damage your cooling system. Your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop can help you select the proper coolant. NOTICE To avoid damaging your cooling system: • Always use a high quality ethylene glycol base non-silicate type coolant diluted with distilled water at the correct mixture concentration. • Make sure that the proper mix is 50/ 50 coolant to distilled water (Diesel) and 30/70 (Petrol) and in no case higher than 70/30. Concentrations greater than 70/30 coolant to distilled water will cause overheating conditions. • Neither use 100% coolant nor 100% plain water. • Do not add extra inhibitors or additives. They may not be compatible with your cooling system. • Do not mix different types of base coolants. Doing so may result in accelerated seal wear and/or the possibility of severe overheating and extensive engine/CVT damage. Coolant Level Check Check the coolant level at the reservoir tank, not at the radiator. With the engine cool, the coolant level should be between the “FULL” and “LOW” marks. Adding Coolant WARNING Swallowing engine coolant can cause severe injury or death. Inhaling coolant mist or vapors or getting coolant in your eyes could result in severe injury. • Do not drink antifreeze or coolant solution. If swallowed, do not induce vomiting. Immediately contact a poison control center or a physician. • Avoid inhaling coolant mist or hot vapors. If inhaled, remove to a fresh air area. • If coolant gets in the eyes, flush with water and seek medical attention. • Wash thoroughly after handling coolant. • Keep engine coolant out of the reach of children and pets. NOTICE • The mixture you use should contain 50% concentration of antifreeze. • If the lowest ambient temperature in your area is expected to be –35°C (–31°F) or below, use higher concentrations up to 60% following the instructions on the antifreeze container. 7-11 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE (For Diesel Engine Model) (For Petrol Engine Model) If the coolant level is below the “LOW” mark, more coolant should be added. When the engine is cool, remove the degassing tank cap by turning it anticlockwise slowly to release any pressure. And add coolant until the degassing tank level reaches the “FULL” mark. Never fill the degassing tank above the “FULL” mark. Coolant Replacement Since special procedures are required, we recommend you take your vehicle to your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for coolant replacement. 68PH00708 If the coolant level is below the “LOW” mark, more coolant should be added. Remove the reservoir tank cap and add coolant until the reservoir tank level reaches the “FULL” mark. Never fill the reservoir tank above the “FULL” mark. NOTICE When putting the cap on the reservoir tank, line up the mark on the cap and the mark on the tank. Failure to follow this can result in coolant leakage. 68PH00709 WARNING It is hazardous to remove the reservoir tank cap (degassing tank cap) for a diesel engine when the water temperature is high, because scalding fluid and steam may be blown out under pressure. Wait until the coolant temperature has lowered before removing the cap. 7-12 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Air Cleaner Spark Plugs For Diesel Engine Model If the air cleaner is clogged with dust, there will be greater intake resistance, resulting in decreased power output and increased fuel consumption. Unclamp the side clamps or loosen the screws, and remove the element from the air cleaner case. If it appears to be dirty, replace it with a new one. Clamp the side clamps or tighten the screws securely. Replacing and inspection of spark plugs Since special procedures, materials and tools are required, it is recommended that you trust this job to your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. For Petrol Engine Model 68PH00711 68PH00710 7-13 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Gear Oil Manual Transaxle Oil When adding gear oil, use gear oil with the appropriate viscosity and grade as shown in the chart below. We highly recommend you use: “MARUTI GENUINE GEAR OIL 75W-80” for manual transaxle gear oil. Manual transaxle oil 75W-80 o C -30 F -22 o -20 -4 -10 14 0 32 10 50 20 68 30 86 40 104 68LM728 (1) Oil filler and level plug (for petrol engine model) (2) Oil filler and level plug (for diesel engine model) To check the gear oil level, use the following procedure: 1) Park the vehicle on a level surface with the parking brake applied. Then, stop the engine. 2) Remove the oil filler and level plug (1) or (2). 3) If gear oil flows from the plug hole, the oil level is correct. Reinstall the plug. If gear oil does not flow from the plug hole, add oil through the filler plug hole until oil flows a little from the plug hole. NOTICE When tightening the plug, apply the following sealing compound or equivalent to the plug threads to prevent oil leakage. MARUTI SUZUKI Bond No. “1216E” or “1217G” Gear Oil Change Since special procedures, materials and tools are required, it is recommended that you trust this job to your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Tightening torque for oil filler and level plug (1) or (2) Manual transaxle: 21 Nm (2.1 kg-m, 15.5 lb-ft) Gear Oil Level Check EXAMPLE (1) CAUTION After driving the vehicle, the gear oil temperature may be high enough to burn you. Wait until the oil filler is cool enough to touch with your bare hands before inspecting gear oil level. (2) 68PH00712 7-14 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Clutch Pedal Fluid Control Clutch (if equipped) Cable Control Clutch (if equipped) Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT) Fluid Specified Fluid EXAMPLE Use a CVT fluid SUZUKI CVT FLUID GREEN-2. MAX Fluid Level Check NOTICE 54G274 Clutch pedal play “d”: 10 - 15 mm (0.4 - 0.6 in.) Measure the clutch pedal play by moving the clutch pedal with your hand and measuring the distance it moves until you feel slight resistance. The play in the clutch pedal should be between the specified values. If the play is more or less than the above, or clutch dragging is felt with the pedal fully depressed, have the clutch inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. MIN Driving with too much or too little fluid can damage the transaxle. 68PH00713 You must check the fluid level with the CVT fluid at normal operating temperature. Check the clutch pedal for smooth operation and clutch fluid level from time to time. If clutch dragging is felt with the pedal fully depressed, have the clutch inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. If the clutch fluid level is near the “MIN” line, fill it up to the “MAX” line with SAE J1703 or Maruti Genuine Brake Fluid (MGBF) or DOT3 brake fluid. To check the fluid level: 1) To warm up the CVT fluid, drive the vehicle or idle the engine until the temperature gauge indicates normal operating temperature. 2) Then drive for ten more minutes. NOTICE Be sure to use the specified CVT fluid. Using CVT fluid other than SUZUKI CVT FLUID GREEN-2 may damage the CVT of your vehicle. 7-15 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE NOTE: Do not check the fluid level if you have just driven the vehicle for a long time at high speed, or if you have driven in city traffic in hot weather. Wait until the fluid cools down (about 30 minutes), or the fluid level indication will not be correct. 3) Park your vehicle on level ground. 4) Apply the parking brake and then start the engine in “P” (Park). Let it idle for two minutes and keep it running during the fluid level check. 5) With your foot on the brake pedal, move the gearshift lever through each gear, pausing for about three seconds in each range. Then move it back to the “P” (Park) position. WARNING 6) The handle of the CVT fluid dipstick is colored red for easy identification. Remove the dipstick, clean it and push it back in until the cap seats. Then pull out the dipstick. 7) Check both sides of the dipstick, and read the lowest level. The fluid level should be between the two marks in the “HOT” range on the dipstick. EXAMPLE NOTICE After checking or adding oil, be sure to insert the dipstick securely. 68PH00715 EXAMPLE Since special procedures, materials and tools are required to check the deterioration of CVT oil or change, it is recommended that you trust this job to your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. (1) (3) Be sure to depress the brake pedal when moving the gearshift lever, or the vehicle can move suddenly. Deterioration Checking or Changing Oil (2) EXAMPLE 68PH00716 (1) FULL (2) LOW (3) The lowest point = Fluid level 68PH00714 7-16 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Fuel Filter (Diesel engine) If the fuel filter warning light comes on when driving, there is a possibility that water is in the fuel filter. Drain water as soon as possible. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Brakes WARNING Brake Fluid MAX MIN 68PH00713 Check the brake fluid level by looking at the reservoir in the engine compartment. Check that the fluid level is between the “MAX” and “MIN” lines. If the brake fluid level is near the “MIN” line, fill it up to the “MAX” line with SAE J1703 or Maruti Genuine Brake Fluid (MGBF) or DOT3 brake fluid. Failure to follow the guidelines below can result in personal injury or serious damage to the brake system. • If the brake fluid in the reservoir drops below a certain level, the brake warning light on the instrument panel will come on (the engine must be running with the parking brake fully disengaged). Should the light come on, immediately ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to inspect the brake system. • A rapid fluid loss indicates a leak in the brake system which should be inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop immediately. • Do not use any fluid other than SAE J1703 or DOT3 brake fluid. Do not use reclaimed fluid or fluid that has been stored in old or open containers. It is essential that foreign particles and other liquids are kept out of the brake fluid reservoir. CAUTION Brake fluid can harm your eyes and damage painted surfaces. Use caution when refilling the reservoir. 7-17 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE NOTE: When measuring the distance between the brake pedal and floor wall, be sure not to include the floor mat or rubber on the floor wall in your measurement. WARNING Brake fluid is harmful or fatal if swallowed, and harmful if it comes in contact with skin or eyes. If swallowed, do not induce vomiting. Immediately contact a poison control center or a physician. If brake fluid gets in eyes, flush eyes with water and seek medical attention. Wash thoroughly after handling. Solution can be poisonous to animals. Keep out of the reach of children and animals. NOTE: With disc brakes, the fluid level can be expected to gradually fall as the brake pads wear. Brake Pedal Check if the brake pedal stops at the regular height without “spongy” feeling when you depress it. If not, have the brake system inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. If you doubt the brake pedal for the regular height, check it as follows: 54G108 Pedal to floor carpet minimum distance “a”: 53 mm (2.1 in.) With the engine running, measure the distance between the brake pedal and floor carpet when the pedal is depressed with approximately 30 kg (66 lbs) of force. The minimum distance required is as specified. Since your vehicle’s brake system is selfadjusting, there is no need for pedal adjustment. If the pedal to floor carpet distance as measured above is less than the minimum distance required, have your vehicle inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 60G104S WARNING If you experience any of the following problems with your vehicle’s brake system, have the vehicle inspected immediately by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. • Poor braking performance • Uneven braking (brakes not working uniformly on all wheels.) • Excessive pedal travel • Brake dragging • Excessive noise 7-18 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Steering Parking Brake EXAMPLE Tires EXAMPLE (1) “c” “b” EXAMPLE 68PM7001 Ratchet tooth specification “b”: 4th – 9th Lever pull force (1): 200 N (20 kg, 45 lbs) Check the parking brake for proper adjustment by counting the number of clicks made by the ratchet teeth as you slowly pull up on the parking brake lever to the point of full engagement. The parking brake lever should stop between the specified ratchet teeth and the rear wheels should be securely locked. If the parking brake is not properly adjusted or the brakes drag after the lever has been fully released, have the parking brake inspected and/or adjusted by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 68LM708 Steering wheel play “c”: 0 – 30 mm (0.0 – 1.2 in.) Check the play of the steering wheel by gently turning it from left to right and measuring the distance that it moves before you feel slight resistance. The play should be between the specified values. Check that the steering wheel turns easily and smoothly without rattling by turning it all the way to the right and to the left while driving very slowly in an open area. If the amount of free play is outside the specification or you find anything else to be wrong, an inspection must be performed by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 68PH00717 The front and rear tire pressure specifications for your vehicle are listed on the Tire Information Label. Both the front and rear tires should have the specified tire pressure. Note that the value does not apply to the compact spare tire, if equipped. Tire Inspection Inspect your vehicle’s tires at least once a month by performing the following checks: 1) Measure the air pressure with a tire gauge. Adjust the pressure if necessary. Remember to check the spare tire, too. 7-19 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE WARNING • Air pressures should be checked when the tires are cold or you may get inaccurate readings. • Check the inflation pressure from time to time while inflating the tire gradually, until the specified pressure is obtained. • Never underinflate or overinflate the tires. Underinflation can cause unusual handling characteristics or can cause the rim to slip on the tire bead, resulting in an accident or damage to the tire or rim. Overinflation can cause the tire to burst, resulting in personal injury. Overinflation can also cause unusual handling characteristics which may result in an accident. CAUTION EXAMPLE Hitting curbs and running over rocks can damage tires and affect wheel alignment. Be sure to have tires and wheel alignment checked periodically by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 4) Check for loose wheel nuts. 5) Check that there are no nails, stones or other objects sticking into the tires. (2) 68PH00718 (1) Tread wear indicator (2) Indicator location mark 2) Check that the depth of the tread groove is more than 1.6 mm (0.06 in.). To help you check this, the tires have molded-in tread wear indicators in the grooves. When the indicators appear on the tread surface, the remaining depth of the tread is 1.6 mm (0.06 in.) or less and the tire should be replaced. 3) Check for abnormal wear, cracks and damage. Any tires with cracks or other damage should be replaced. If any tires show abnormal wear, have them inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 7-20 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE WARNING • Your MARUTI SUZUKI is equipped with tires which are all the same type and size. This is important to ensure proper steering and handling of the vehicle. Never mix tires of different size or type on the four wheels of your vehicle. The size and type of tires used should be only those approved by MARUTI SUZUKI as standard or optional equipment for your vehicle. • Replacing the wheels and tires equipped on your vehicle with certain combinations of aftermarket wheels and tires can significantly change the steering and handling characteristics of your vehicle. • Therefore, use only those wheel and tire combinations approved by MARUTI SUZUKI as standard or optional equipment for your vehicle. Tire Rotation To avoid uneven wear of your tires and to prolong their life, rotate the tires as illustrated. Tires should be rotated every 10000 km. After rotation, adjust front and rear tire pressures to the specification listed on your vehicle’s Tire Information Label. 4-tire rotation (vehicle with 195/55R16 87H tire) Wheel Balancing If the vehicle vibrates abnormally on smooth road, have the wheel balanced at authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 54G114 5-tire rotation (Vehicle with 185/65R15 88S tire) NOTICE Replacing the original tires with tires of a different size may result in false speedometer or odometer readings. Check with your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop before purchasing replacement tires that differ in size from the original tires. 68PH00755 Wheel Alignment In case of abnormal tyre wear or pulling towards one side, have the wheel aligned at authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Tubeless Tyres (If equipped) The vehicle is equipped with Tubeless Tyres. In tubeless tyre, a thin layer of butyl rubber is used for lining the inside of the tubeless tyre. This layer is to prevent air loss and fulfilling the purpose of tube. The air pressure is maintained by the sealing between tyre bead and wheel rim. Tubeless tyres are having advantage of slow air loss and preventing sudden deflation while driving. Care and maintenance tips for tubeless tyres 1) Always maintain recommended inflation pressure. Driving continuously at low inflation pressure can lead to tyre damage. 2) In case any leakage is found, check for any nail penetration/valve core dam- 7-21 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE 3) 4) 5) 6) 7) 8) age or rim bent. Damaged wheel must not be used. In case tyre has run at low pressure, it must be inspected for any defect. Whenever new tyre is fitted, replace the valve. If continuous high speed driving is required, increase tyres pressure by 5 psi over recommended inflation pressure. Never run the tyre beyond TWI (Tread wear indicator). The tyre is recommended to be replaced when the remaining tread has worn to this point. The indicators are spaced across the tread around the tyre marked by a triangular symbol (TWI). Always prefer tubeless tyre mounting machine. In case of manual mountingtyre/wheel rim damage may occur. In case of any problem, please get in touch with authorised MARUTI SUZUKI workshop. Temporary Spare Tire (if equipped) Your vehicle comes equipped with the temporary spare tire. It is only intended for temporary emergency use, until the conventional tire can be repaired or replaced. The inflation pressure of the temporary spare tire should be checked at least monthly. At the same time, check that the tire is stored securely. If it is not, tighten it. Note that two or more temporary spare tires should not be used on one vehicle simultaneously. WARNING The temporary spare tire and wheel are intended for temporary emergency use only. Continuous use of this spare can result in tire failure and loss of control. Always observe these precautions when using this spare: • Your vehicle will handle differently with this temporary spare. • Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph) speed (only vehicle with 195/55R16 87H tire). • Replace this spare with a standard tire and wheel as soon as possible. • Use of this spare will reduce ground clearance. • Set the specified tire pressure indicated on the tire information label located on the driver’s door lock pillar. • Do not use tire chains on the temporary spare. If you must use tire chains, rearrange the wheels so standard tires and wheels are fitted to the front axle. • The temporary spare tire has a much shorter tread life than the conventional tires on your vehicle. Replace the tire as soon as the tread wear indicator appears. • When replacing the temporary spare tire, use a replacement tire with the exact same size and construction. 7-22 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Battery Replacement of the battery (For Petrol Engine Model) EXAMPLE WARNING • Batteries produce flammable hydrogen gas. Keep flames and sparks away from the battery or an explosion may occur. Never smoke when working in the vicinity of the battery. • When checking or servicing the battery, disconnect the negative cable. Be careful not to cause a short circuit by allowing metal objects to contact the battery posts and the vehicle at the same time. • To avoid harm to yourself or damage to your vehicle or battery, follow the jump starting instructions in the “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section of this manual if it is necessary to jump start your vehicle. • Diluted sulfuric acid spilled from battery can cause blindness or severe burns. Use proper eye protection and gloves. Flush eyes or body with ample water and get medical care immediately if suffered. Keep batteries out of the reach of children. EXAMPLE (3) (1) (2) (4) 54GM701 For maintenance-free battery (cap-less type), you need not add water. For traditional type battery, which has water filler caps, the level of the battery solution must be kept between the “MAX” and the “MIN” level lines at all times. If the level is found to be below the “MIN” level line, add distilled water to the “MAX” level line. You should periodically check the battery, battery terminals, and battery hold-down bracket for corrosion. Remove corrosion using a stiff brush and ammonia mixed with water, or baking soda mixed with water. After removing corrosion, rinse with clean water. If your vehicle is not going to be driven for a month or longer, disconnect the cable from the negative terminal of the battery to help prevent discharge. 68PH00719 (For Diesel Engine Model) EXAMPLE (1) (2) (4) (3) 68PH00720 7-23 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE To remove the battery: 1) Disconnect the negative cable (1). 2) Disconnect the positive cable (2). Fuses For Petrol Engine Model; 3) Remove the retainer nuts (3) and remove the retainer (4). Main fuse The main fuse takes current directly from the battery. For Diesel Engine Model; 3) Remove the bracket bolt (3) and remove the bracket (4). 4) Remove the battery. To install the battery: 1) Install the battery in the reverse order of removal. 2) Tighten the bracket bolt and battery cables securely. Your vehicle has three types of fuses, as described below: Primary fuses These fuses are between the main fuse and individual fuses, and are for electrical load groups. (5) (5) (4) (4) (3) (6) (1) (3) (1) (2) (2) Individual fuses These fuses are for individual electrical circuits. 74LHT0715 To remove a fuse, use the fuse puller (1) provided in the fuse cover. (35) (36) (37) (31) (1) (32) (38) (39) (40) (41) NOTE: When the battery is disconnected, some of the vehicle’s function will be initialized and/ or deactivated. These function are required to reset after the battery is reconnected. Fuses in the Engine Compartment (33) (34) (20) (21) (22) (23) (24) (25) (26) (27) (28) (29) (30) (12) (13) (14) (15) (16) (17) (18) (19) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) 68PH00722 68PH00721 7-24 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE MAIN FUSE / PRIMARY FUSE (1) 120 A FL1 (2) 100 A FL2 (3) 80 A FL3 (4) 100 A FL4 (5) 50 A FL5 (6) 150 A FL6 (7) 30 A Starting motor (8) 30 A Blower fan (9) 40 A Battery (10) 40 A ABS motor (11) 40 A Ignition switch (12) 30 A B/U (13) 30 A Sub battery (14) – Blank (15) – Blank (16) 25 A ABS control module (17) 15 A Headlight (Left) (18) 15 A Headlight (Right) (19) – Blank (20) – Blank (21) 30 A Radiator fan (22) 60 A Power steering (23) 5A ECM (24) 20 A Fuel pump (25) 20 A Front fog light (26) 10 A Air compressor (27) 50 A Ignition switch 2 (28) 15 A Transaxle 15 A FI (GAS) 30 A FI main (DIESEL) (30) 15 A CVT pump (31) – Blank (32) – Blank (33) 5A (29) The main fuse, primary fuses and some of the individual fuses are located in the engine compartment. If the main fuse blows, no electrical component will function. If a primary fuse blows, no electrical component in the corresponding load group will function. When replacing the main fuse, a primary fuse or an individual fuse, use a Maruti Genuine Part. To remove a fuse, use the fuse puller provided in the fuse box. The amperage of each fuse is shown in the back of the fuse box cover. Starting Signal (34) – (35) 20 A Blank (36) – (37) 10 A (38) – (39) 25 A Headlight high (40) 15 A Headlight high (Right) (41) 15 A Headlight high (Left) INJ DRV (DIESEL) Blank FI (DIESEL) Blank 7-25 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Fuses under the Dash Board EXAMPLE PRIMARY FUSE OK BLOWN 68PH00723 EXAMPLE 68PH00724 WARNING If the main fuse or a primary fuse blows, be sure to have your vehicle inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Always use a Maruti Genuine Part. Never use a substitute such as a wire even for a temporary repair, or extensive electrical damage and a fire can result. NOTE: Make sure that the fuse box always carries spare fuses. For vehicle without keyless push start system or keyless entry system (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) (14) (15) (16) (17) (18) (19) (20) (21) (22) (23) (1) 10 A Back-up light (2) 15 A Ignition coil (3) 10 A Meter (4) 10 A Wiper (5) 5A Ignition-2 signal (6) 15 A Washer (7) 25 A Front wiper (8) 10 A Tail light (9) 10 A Hazard (10) 10 A Stop light (11) 30 A Power window (12) 15 A ACC-2 (13) 5A ACC (14) 5A Starting signal (15) 10 A Ignition-1 signal (16) 10 A Air bag 5A ABS control module (if equipped) (18) 15 A Horn (19) 20 A Door lock (20) 25 A Rear defogger (17) 68PH00725 7-26 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE (21) 15 A Radio (22) 5A Dome light (23) 10 A Dome light-2 PRIMARY FUSE For vehicle with keyless push start system or keyless entry system (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) (14) (15) (16) (17) (18) (19) (20) (21) (22) (23) (24) (25) (26) (27) (28) (29) (30) (31) (32) (33) (34) (35) (36) (37) (38) (39) (40) 68PH00759 (1) 30 A Power window (2) 10 A Meter (3) 15 A Ignition coil (4) 5A Ignition-1 signal 2 (5) – Blank (6) – Blank (7) – Blank (8) 20 A Door lock (9) 15 A Steering lock (10) 10 A Hazard (11) 5A A-STOP controller* (12) 10 A RR fog lamp (13) 5A ABS control module (14) 15 A Seat heater (15) 5A Ignition-1 signal 3 (16) 10 A Dome light-2 (17) 5A Dome light (18) 15 A Radio (19) 5A CONT (20) 5A Key 2 (21) 20 A Power window timer (22) 5A Key (23) 15 A Horn (24) 5A Tail light (Left) (25) 10 A Tail light (26) 10 A Air bag (27) 10 A Ignition-1 signal (28) 10 A Back-up light (29) 5A ACC-3 (30) 20 A Rear defogger (31) 10 A Heated mirror (32) 15 A ACC-2 (33) 5A ACC (34) 10 A Wiper (35) 5A Ignition-2 signal (36) 15 A Washer (37) 25 A Front wiper (38) 10 A Stop light (39) – (40) 25 A Blank Rear defogger 2 * Feature not available in the vehicle. 7-27 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Headlight Aiming Since special procedures are required, we recommend you take your vehicle to your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for headlight alignment. OK BLO W N 81A283 WARNING Always be sure to replace a blown fuse with a fuse of the correct amperage. Never use a substitute such as aluminum foil or wire to replace a blown fuse. If you replace a fuse and the new one blows in a short period of time, you may have a major electrical problem. Have your vehicle inspected immediately by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Bulb Replacement CAUTION • Light bulbs can be hot enough to burn your finger right after being turned off. This is true especially for halogen headlight bulbs. Replace the bulbs after they become cool enough. • The headlight bulbs are filled with pressurized halogen gas. They can burst and injure you if they are hit or dropped. Handle them carefully. • To avoid injury by sharp-edged parts of the body, wear gloves and a long-sleeved shirt when replacing light bulbs. NOTICE The oils from your skin may cause a halogen bulb to overheat and burst when the lights are on. Grasp a new bulb with a clean cloth. NOTICE Frequent replacement of a bulb indicates the need for an inspection of the electrical system. This should be carried out by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 7-28 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Headlights Discharge headlights Since special procedures are required, we recommend you take your vehicle to your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for bulb replacement. (2) (1) WARNING Never attempt to replace the bulb of a discharge headlight, or you could suffer an electric shock from the high-voltage circuit in the headlight system. Always have a discharge headlight bulb replaced by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 68PH00728 NOTE: You can see the position of retaining spring from the hole of headlight. Halogen headlights WARNING (1) (3) Don’t twist/shake the bulb coupler while removing as it may disturb the terminal gap leading to loose connection and sparking causing subsequent coupler melting/ fire. 68PH00727 Open the engine food. Disconnect the coupler (1). Remove the sealing rubber (2). 68PH00726 (1) Headlight (High/Low Beam) Push the retaining spring (3) forward and unhook it. Then remove the bulb. Install a new bulb in the reverse order of removal. 7-29 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Side Turn Signal Light (on fender) (if equipped) EXAMPLE (2) (3) (4) (5) (1) 68PH00760 68PH00729 1) Remove the light housing (1) by sliding to left with your finger. 2) Turn the bulb holder (2) clockwise and pull it out from the light housing. 68PH00761 (4) Removal (5) Install 3) To remove and install the bulb of the side turn signal light (3), simply pull out or push in the bulb. 7-30 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Front turn signal light and front position light Vehicle with the discharge headlights EXAMPLE Vehicle with the halogen headlights (1) (1) 68PH00731 (2) (1) Front turn signal light 68PH00730 (1) Front turn signal light (2) Front position light 68PH00732 1) Open the engine hood. To remove the bulb holder of the front turn signal light or the front position light from the light housing, turn the holder counterclockwise and pull it out. 7-31 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Front Fog Light (if equipped) EXAMPLE 1) Start the engine. Turn the steering wheel to the opposite side of the replacing fog light to replace the bulb easily. Then turn off the engine. EXAMPLE (2) (3) (4) (1) (1) EXAMPLE 68PH00733 68PH00735 (3) Removal (4) Installation 2) To remove the bulb of the front turn signal light (1) from the bulb holder, push in the bulb and turn it counterclockwise. To install a new bulb, push it in and turn it clockwise. To remove and install the bulb of the front position light (2), simply pull out or push in the bulb. 3) Open the end of the cover inside the fender. 68PH00734 2) Remove the clips (1). 7-32 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE EXAMPLE Rear combination light (3) (2) (1) (4) 68PH00736 4) Disconnect the coupler by pushing the lock release. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise and remove it. 68PH00738 68PH00737 1) Remove the bolts (1) and pull the light housing (2) straight. 2) Remove the wire (3) from a clamp (4). 7-33 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE EXAMPLE (5) (6) (6) (7) (8) 68PH00739 3) To remove the bulb holder of the rear turn signal light (5) or the reversing light (6) from the light housing, turn the holder counterclockwise and pull it out. (5) 68PH00740 (7) Removal (8) Installation 4) To remove the bulb of the rear turn signal light (5) from the bulb holder, push in the bulb and turn it counterclockwise. To install a new bulb, push it in and turn it clockwise. To remove and install the bulb of the reversing light (6), simply pull out or push in the bulb. 68PH00741 NOTE: When reinstalling the light housing, check that the clips are properly attached. 7-34 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE License Plate Light Interior Light Remove the lens by using a flat blade screwdriver covered with a soft cloth as shown. To install it, simply push it back in. Front (if equipped) (2) (1) 68PH00743 68PH00742 1) Turn the cover (1) counterclockwise to remove it. 2) To remove and install the bulb of the license plate light (2), simply pull out or push in the bulb. 68PH00744 7-35 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Center Glove Box Light (if equipped) Courtesy light (if equipped) 68PH00745 Since special procedures are required, we recommend you take your vehicle to your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for bulb replacement. 68PH00747 Luggage compartment (if equipped) EXAMPLE 68PH00748 1) Press inward on both sides of the glove box and pull frontward and then unclamp it. 68PH00746 7-36 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Wiper Blades NOTE: Some wiper blades may be different from the ones described here depending on vehicle specifications. If so, consult your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for proper replacement method. For windshield wipers: (1) EXAMPLE 68PH00749 2) To remove and install the bulb of the glove box light (1), simply pull out or push in the bulb. 54G129 If the wiper blades become brittle or damaged, or make streaks when wiping, replace the wiper blades. To install new wiper blades, follow the procedures below. NOTICE To avoid scratching or breaking the window, do not let the wiper arm strike the window while replacing the wiper blade. 70G119 1) Hold the wiper arm away from the window. NOTE: When raising both of the front wiper arms, pull the driver’s side wiper arm up first. When returning the wiper arms, lower the passenger’s side wiper arm first. Otherwise, the wiper arms may interfere with each other. 7-37 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Removal EXAMPLE EXAMPLE EXAMPLE (3) (3) EXAMPLE 68PH00751 Installation EXAMPLE 68PH00753 (3) Retainer 4) If the new blade is provided without the two metal retainers, move them from the old blade to the new one. EXAMPLE (3) 68PH00750 2) Squeeze lock (1) towards wiper arm (2) and remove the wiper frame from the arm as shown. 3) Unlock the lock end of the wiper blade and slide the blade out as shown. 68PH00752 (3) (1) Locked end 68PH00754 7-38 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE For rear wipers: EXAMPLE EXAMPLE (A) (B) (3) EXAMPLE 60MHM7001 68PH00764 (A) Up (B) Down NOTE: Do not flex the wiper blade frame end more than necessary. If you do, it can break off. NOTE: When you install the metal retainers (3), make sure the direction of metal retainers as shown in the above illustrations. 5) Install the new blade in the reverse order of removal, with the locked end positioned toward the wiper arm. Make sure the blade is properly retained by all the hooks. Lock the blade end into place. 6) Reinstall wiper frame to arm, making sure that the lock lever is snapped securely into the arm. 68PH00763 1) Hold the wiper arm away from the window. 2) Remove the wiper frame from the arm as shown. 3) Slide the blade out as shown. 7-39 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Windshield Washer Fluid EXAMPLE EXAMPLE Check that there is washer fluid in the tank. Refill it if necessary. Use a good quality windshield washer fluid, diluted with water as necessary. WARNING (1) Do not use radiator antifreeze in the windshield washer reservoir. This can severely impair visibility when sprayed on the windshield, and can also damage your vehicle’s paint. (1) NOTICE 68PH00765 (1) Retainer 4) If the new blade is provided without the two metal retainers, move them from the old blade to the new one. 5) Install the new blade in the reverse order of removal. Check that the blade is properly retained by all the hooks. 6) Reinstall wiper frame to arm in the reverse order of removal. 68PH00756 Damage may result if the washer motor is operated with no fluid in the washer tank. 7-40 68PH0-74E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Air Conditioning System If you do not use the air conditioner for a long period, such as during winter, it may not give the best performance when you start using it again. To help maintain optimum performance and durability of your air conditioner, it needs to be run periodically. Operate the air conditioner at least once a month for one minute with the engine idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil and helps protect the internal components. Replacement of the Air Conditioner Filter (if equipped) Since special procedures are required, we recommend you take your vehicle to your SUZUKI dealer for the air conditioner filter replacement. (3) (1) EXAMPLE (2) 68PH00758 2) Remove the cover (1) and pull out the air conditioner filter (2). 68PH00757 NOTE: When you install a new filter, make sure the UP mark (3) faces upward. 1) To approach the air conditioner filter, press inward on both sides of the grove box, pull it frontward and remove it. 7-41 68PH0-74E EMERGENCY SERVICE EMERGENCY SERVICE Tire Changing Tool ............................................................. 8-1 Jacking Instructions ........................................................... 8-1 Changing Wheels ................................................................ 8-4 Jump Starting Instructions ................................................ 8-5 Towing .................................................................................. 8-6 If the Starter Does Not Operate .......................................... 8-7 If the Engine is Flooded ...................................................... 8-7 If the Engine Overheats ...................................................... 8-8 Warning Triangle ................................................................. 8-9 8 60G411 68PH0-74E EMERGENCY SERVICE Tire Changing Tool Jacking Instructions WARNING EXAMPLE After using the tire changing tools, be sure to stow them securely or they can cause injury if an accident occurs. (1) (2) (3) EXAMPLE CAUTION The jack should be used only to change wheels. It is important to read the jacking instructions in this section before attempting to use the jack. 68PH00802 61MM0B100 1) Place the vehicle on level, hard ground. 2) Set the parking brake firmly and shift into “P” (Park) if your vehicle has a CVT, or shift into “R” (Reverse) if your vehicle has a manual transaxle. (1) Jack (2) Wheel brace (3) Jack handle The tire changing tools are stowed in the luggage compartment. Refer to “Luggage Compartment” in the “ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS” section. WARNING (1) 68PH00801 To remove the spare tire, turn the bolt (1) counterclockwise and remove it. • Be sure to shift into “P” (Park) for a CVT vehicle, or into “R” (Reverse) for a manual transaxle vehicle when you jack up the vehicle. • Never jack up the vehicle with the transaxle in “N” (Neutral). Otherwise, unstable jack may cause an accident. 8-1 68PH0-74E EMERGENCY SERVICE 3) Turn on the hazard warning flasher if your vehicle is near traffic. 4) Block the front and rear of the wheel diagonally opposite of the wheel being lifted. 5) Place the spare wheel near the wheel being lifted as shown in the illustration in case that the jack slips. EXAMPLE 7) Continue to raise the jack slowly and smoothly until the tire clears the ground. Do not raise the vehicle more than necessary. WARNING 68PH00803 EXAMPLE 54G253 • Use the jack only to change wheels on level, hard ground. • Never jack up the vehicle on an inclined surface. • Never raise the vehicle with the jack in a location other than the specified jacking point (shown in the illustration) near the wheel to be changed. • Make sure that the jack is raised at least 50 mm (2 inch) before it contacts the flange. Use of the jack when it is within 50 mm (2 inch) of being fully collapsed may result in failure of the jack. • Never get under the vehicle when it is supported by the jack. • Never run the engine when the vehicle is supported by the jack and never allow passengers to remain in the vehicle. 68PH00804 6) Position the jack at an angle as shown in the illustration and raise the jack by turning the jack handle clockwise until the jack-head groove fits around the jacking bar beneath the vehicle body. 8-2 68PH0-74E EMERGENCY SERVICE To Raise the Vehicle with a Garage Jack Front jacking point for garage jack (1) Rear jacking point for garage jack (2) EXAMPLE • Apply the garage jack to one of the points indicated below. • Always support the raised vehicle with jack stands (commercially available) at the points indicated below. (2) 68PH00806 Application point for jack stand (3) or two-column lift EXAMPLE (1) EXAMPLE 68PH00805 (3) (3) 68PH00807 8-3 68PH0-74E EMERGENCY SERVICE NOTICE Never apply a garage jack to the exhaust pipe, side under spoiler (if equipped), engine undercover or rear torsion beam. NOTE: For more details, please contact an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. Changing Wheels To change a wheel, use the following procedure: 1) Clear all passengers and luggage from the vehicle. 2) Remove the jack, tools and spare wheel from the vehicle. 3) Loosen, but do not remove the wheel nuts. 4) Jack up the vehicle. 5) Remove the wheel nuts and wheel. 6) Before installing the new wheel, clean any mud or dirt off from the surface of the wheel and hub with a clean cloth. Clean the hub carefully; it may be hot from driving. 7) Install the new wheel and replace the wheel nuts with their cone shaped end facing the wheel. Tighten each nut snugly by hand until the wheel is securely seated on the hub. EXAMPLE Loosen Tighten 68PH00808 Tightening torque for wheel nut 100 Nm (10.2 kg-m, 74.0 lb-ft) 8) Lower the jack and fully tighten the nuts in a crisscross fashion with a wrench as shown in the illustration. WARNING Use genuine wheel nuts and tighten them to the specified torque as soon as possible after changing wheels. Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly tightened wheel nuts may come loose or fall off, which can result in an accident. If you do not have a torque wrench, have the wheel nut torque checked by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 8-4 68PH0-74E EMERGENCY SERVICE Full Wheel Cover (if equipped) EXAMPLE Jump Starting Instructions WARNING 68PH00809 (1) or (2) Flat end tool Your vehicle includes two tools, a wheel brace and a jack crank, one of which has a flat end. Use the tool with the flat end to remove the full wheel cap, as shown above. EXAMPLE 68PH00810 When installing the cover, make sure that it is positioned so that it does not cover or foul the air valve. • Never attempt to jump start your vehicle if the battery appears to be frozen. Batteries in this condition may explode or rupture if jump starting is attempted. • When making jump lead connections, be certain that your hands and the jump leads remain clear from pulleys, belts, or fans. • Batteries produce flammable hydrogen gas. Keep flames and sparks away from the battery or an explosion may occur. Never smoke when working in the vicinity of the battery. • If the booster battery you use for jump starting is installed in another vehicle, make sure the two vehicles are not touching each other. • If your battery discharges repeatedly, for no apparent reason, have your vehicle inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. • To avoid harm to yourself or damage to your vehicle or battery, follow the jump starting instructions below precisely and in order. If you are in doubt, call for qualified road service. NOTICE Your vehicle should not be started by pushing or towing. This starting method could result in permanent damage to the catalytic converter. Use jump leads to start a vehicle with a weak or flat battery. When Jump Starting Your Vehicle, Use the Following Procedure: 1) Use only a 12-volt battery to jump start your vehicle. Position the good 12-volt battery close to your vehicle so that the jump leads will reach both batteries. When using a battery installed on another vehicle, DO NOT LET THE VEHICLES TOUCH. Set the parking brakes fully on both vehicles. 2) Turn off all vehicle accessories, except those necessary for safety reasons (for example, headlights or hazard lights). 8-5 68PH0-74E EMERGENCY SERVICE WARNING Never connect the jump lead directly to the negative (–) terminal of the discharged battery, or an explosion may occur. (1) CAUTION (3) EXAMPLE (2) 68PH00811 3) Make jump lead connections as follows: 1. Connect one end of the first jump lead to the positive (+) terminal of the flat battery (1). 2. Connect the other end to the positive (+) terminal of the booster battery (2). 3. Connect one end of the second jump lead to the negative (–) terminal of the booster battery (2). 4. Make the final connection to an unpainted, heavy metal part (i.e. engine mount bracket (3)) of the engine of the vehicle with the flat battery (1). Connect the jump lead to the engine mount bracket securely. If the jump lead disconnects from the engine mount bracket because of vibration at the start of the engine, the jump lead could be caught in the drive belts. 4) If the booster battery you are using is fitted to another vehicle, start the engine of the vehicle with the booster battery. Run the engine at moderate speed. 5) Start the engine of the vehicle with the flat battery. 6) Remove the jump leads in the exact reverse order in which you connected them. Towing If you need to have your vehicle towed, contact a professional service. Your dealer can provide you with detailed towing instructions. NOTICE To help avoid damage to your vehicle during towing, proper equipment and towing procedures must be used. 2-Wheel Drive (2WD) CVT CVT vehicles may be towed using either of the following methods. 1) From the front, with the front wheels lifted and the rear wheels on the ground. Before towing, make sure that the parking brake is released. 2) From the rear, with the rear wheels lifted and a dolly under the front wheels. NOTICE Towing the 2WD vehicle with the front wheels on the ground can result in damage to the CVT. 8-6 68PH0-74E EMERGENCY SERVICE 2-Wheel Drive (2WD) Manual Transaxle Manual transaxle vehicles may be towed using either of the following methods. 1) From the front, with the front wheels lifted and the rear wheels on the ground. Before towing, make sure that the parking brake is released. 2) From the rear, with the rear wheels lifted and the front wheels on the ground, provided the steering and drivetrain are in operational condition. Before towing, make sure that transaxle is in neutral, the steering wheel is unlocked (vehicle without keyless push start system - the ignition key should be in the “ACC” position) (vehicle with keyless push start system - the ignition mode is “ACC”), and the steering wheel is secured with a clamping device designed for towing service. If the Starter Does Not Operate 1) Try turning the ignition switch to the “START” position or try pressing the engine switch to change the ignition mode to “START” with the headlights turned on to determine the battery condition. If the headlights go excessively dim or go off, it usually means that either the battery is flat or the battery terminal contact is poor. Recharge the battery or correct battery terminal contact as necessary. 2) If the headlights remain bright, check the fuses. If the reason for failure of the starter is not obvious, there may be a major electrical problem. Have the vehicle inspected by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. If the Engine is Flooded If the engine is flooded with fuel, it may be hard to start. If this happens, press the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and hold it there while cranking the engine. • For petrol engine model, do not operate the starter motor for more than 12 seconds. • For diesel engine model, do not operate the starter motor for more than 30 seconds. NOTE: If the engine refuses to start, the starter motor automatically stops after a certain period of time. After the starter motor has automatically stopped or there is anything abnormal in the engine starting system, the starter motor runs only while the engine switch is pressed/ignition switch is in “on” position. NOTICE The steering column is not strong enough to withstand shocks transmitted from the front wheels during towing. Always unlock the steering wheel before towing. 8-7 68PH0-74E EMERGENCY SERVICE If the Engine Overheats The engine could overheat temporarily under severe driving conditions. If the engine coolant temperature gauge indicates overheating during driving: 1) Turn off the air conditioner, if equipped. 2) Take the vehicle to a safe place and park. 3) Let the engine run at the normal idle speed for a few minutes until the indicator is within the normal, acceptable temperature range between “H” and “C”. WARNING If you see or hear escaping steam, stop the vehicle in a safe place and immediately turn off the engine to let it cool. Do not open the hood when steam is present. When the steam can no longer be seen or heard, open the hood to see if the coolant is still boiling. If it is, you must wait until it stops boiling before you proceed. If the temperature indication does not come down to within the normal, acceptable range: 1) Turn off the engine and check that the water pump belt and pulleys are not damaged or slipping. If any abnormality is found, correct it. 2) Check the coolant level in the reservoir. If it is found to be lower than the “LOW” line, look for leaks at the radiator, water pump, and radiator and heater hoses. If you locate any leaks that may have caused the overheating, do not run the engine until these problems have been corrected. 3) If you do not find a leak, carefully add coolant to the reservoir and then the radiator, if necessary. (Refer to “Engine Coolant” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section.) EXAMPLE 79J007 EXAMPLE NOTE: If your engine overheats and you are unsure what to do, contact your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. 65D350d 8-8 68PH0-74E EMERGENCY SERVICE WARNING • It is hazardous to remove the radiator cap (or degassing tank cap for a diesel engine) when the water temperature is high, because scalding fluid and steam may be blown out under pressure. The cap should only be taken off when the coolant temperature has lowered. • To help prevent personal injury, keep hands, tools and clothing away from the engine cooling fan and air-conditioner fan (if equipped). These electric fans can automatically turn on without warning. Warning Triangle EXAMPLE MHO07001 In case of vehicle break-down or during emergency stopping, where, your vehicle could become a potential traffic hazard, keep the warning triangle, provided with your vehicle, on the road free from any obstacles behind your vehicle so as to warn the approaching traffic, at an approximate distance of 50-100 m. The reflecting side of the triangle should face the on coming traffic. Please activate the hazard warning lamps before alighting the vehicle to keep the warning triangle. EXAMPLE • Remove the warning triangle carefully from the cover as shown by arrow 1. • Open both the reflector arms as shown by arrow and lock the arms with each other with the clip provided in the right arm. Open the bottom stand in counter clock-wise direction as shown by arrow 3. Position the warning triangle behind the vehicle on a plain surface. • Reverse the removal procedure for keeping inside the cover. EXAMPLE MHO07015 MHO07014 8-9 68PH0-74E APPEARANCE CARE APPEARANCE CARE Corrosion Prevention ......................................................... 9-1 Vehicle Cleaning ................................................................. 9-2 60G412 9 68PH0-74E APPEARANCE CARE Corrosion Prevention It is important to take good care of your vehicle to protect it from corrosion. Listed below are instructions for how to maintain your vehicle to prevent corrosion. Please read and follow these instructions carefully. Important Information About Corrosion Common causes of corrosion 1) Accumulation of road salt, dirt, moisture, or chemicals in hard-to-reach areas of the vehicle underbody or frame. 2) Chipping, scratches and any damage to treated or painted metal surfaces resulting from minor accidents or abrasion by stones and gravel. Environmental conditions which accelerate corrosion 1) Road salt, dust control chemicals, sea air or industrial pollution will all accelerate the corrosion of metal. 2) High humidity will increase the rate of corrosion particularly when the temperature range is just above the freezing point. 3) Moisture in certain areas of a vehicle for an extended period of time may promote corrosion even though other body sections may be completely dry. 4) High temperatures will cause an accelerated rate of corrosion to parts of the vehicle which are not well ventilated to permit quick drying. This information illustrates the necessity of keeping your vehicle (particularly the underbody) as clean and dry as possible. It is equally important to repair any damage to the paint or protective coatings as soon as possible. How to Help Prevent Corrosion Wash your vehicle frequently The best way to preserve the finish on your vehicle and to help avoid corrosion is to keep it clean with frequent washing. Wash your vehicle at least once during the winter and once immediately after the winter. Keep your vehicle, particularly the underside, as clean and dry as possible. If you frequently drive on salted roads, your vehicle should be washed at least once a month during the winter. If you live near the ocean, your vehicle should be washed at least once a month throughout the year. For washing instructions, refer to the “Vehicle Cleaning” section. Remove foreign material deposits Foreign material such as salts, chemicals, road oil or tar, tree sap, bird droppings and industrial fall-out may damage the finish of your vehicle if it is left on painted surfaces. Remove these types of deposits as quickly as possible. If these deposits are difficult to wash off, an additional cleaner may be required. Be sure that any cleaner you use is not harmful to painted surfaces and is specifically intended for your purposes. Follow the manufacturer’s directions when using these special cleaners. Repair finish damage Carefully examine your vehicle for damage to the painted surfaces. If you find any chips or scratches in the paint, touch them up immediately to prevent corrosion from starting. If the chips or scratches have gone through to the bare metal, have a qualified body shop make the repair. Keep passenger and luggage compartments clean Moisture, dirt or mud can accumulate under the floor mats and may cause corrosion. Occasionally, check under these mats to ensure that this area is clean and dry. More frequent checks are necessary if the vehicle is used off road or in wet weather. Certain cargos such as chemicals, fertilizers, cleaners, salts, etc. are extremely corrosive by nature. These products should be transported in sealed containers. If a 9-1 68PH0-74E APPEARANCE CARE spill or leak does occur, clean and dry the area immediately. Store your vehicle in a dry, well-ventilated area Do not park your vehicle in a damp, poorly ventilated area. If you often wash your vehicle in the garage or if you frequently drive it in when wet, your garage may be damp. The high humidity in the garage may cause or accelerate corrosion. A wet vehicle may corrode even in a heated garage if the ventilation is poor. Vehicle Cleaning Cleaning the Interior EXAMPLE WARNING Do not apply additional undercoating or rust preventive coating on or around exhaust system components such as the catalytic converter, exhaust pipes, etc. A fire could be started if the undercoating substance becomes overheated. 76G044S WARNING When cleaning the interior or exterior of the vehicle, NEVER USE flammable solvents such as lacquer thinners, petrol, benzene or cleaning materials such as bleaches or strong household detergents. The materials could cause personal injury or damage to the vehicle. Vinyl upholstery Prepare a solution of soap or mild detergent mixed with warm water. Apply the solution to the vinyl with a sponge or soft cloth and let it soak for a few minutes to loosen dirt. Rub the surface with a clean, damp cloth to remove dirt and the soap solution. If some dirt still remains on the surface, repeat this procedure. Fabric upholstery Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner. Using a mild soap solution, rub stained areas with a clean damp cloth. To remove soap, rub the areas again with a cloth dampened with water. Repeat this until the stain is removed, or use a commercial fabric cleaner for tougher stains. If you use a fabric cleaner, carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and precautions. 9-2 68PH0-74E APPEARANCE CARE Leather upholstery Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner. Using a mild soap or saddle soap solution, wipe dirt off with a clean damp soft cloth. To remove soap, wipe the areas again with a soft cloth dampened with water. Wipe the areas dry with a soft dry cloth. Repeat this until the dirt or stain is removed, or use a commercial leather cleaner for tougher dirt or stains. If you use a leather cleaner, carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and precautions. Do not use solvent type cleaners or abrasive cleaners. NOTE: • In order to keep leather upholstery looking good, it should be cleaned at least twice a year. • If leather upholstery becomes wet, immediately wipe it dry with tissue paper or a soft cloth. Water may cause leather to harden and shrink if it is not wiped off. • When parking on sunny days, select a shady place or use a sunshade. If leather upholstery is exposed to direct sunlight for a long time, it may discolor and shrink. • As it is common with natural materials, leather is inherently irregular in grain and cowhide has spots in its natural state. These do not affect the performance of the leather in any way. Seat belts Clean seat belts with a mild soap and water. Do not use bleach or dye on the belts. They may weaken the fabric in the belts. Vinyl floor mats Ordinary dirt can be removed from vinyl with water or mild soap. Use a brush to help loosen dirt. After the dirt is loosened, rinse the mat thoroughly with water and dry it in the shade. Carpets Remove dirt and soil as much as possible with a vacuum cleaner. Using a mild soap solution, rub stained areas with a clean damp cloth. To remove soap, rub the areas again with a cloth dampened with water. Repeat this until the stain is removed, or use a commercial carpet cleaner for tougher stains. If you use a carpet cleaner, carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and precautions. Instrument panel and console Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner. Gently wipe dirt off with a tightly squeezed damp clean cloth. Repeat this until the dirt is removed. NOTICE Do not use chemical products that contain silicon to wipe electrical components such as the air conditioning system, audio, navigation system, or other switches. These will cause damage to the components. Cleaning the Exterior NOTICE It is important that your vehicle be kept clean and free from dirt. Failure to keep your vehicle clean may result in fading of the paint or corrosion to various parts of the vehicle body. Caring for Aluminum Wheels NOTE: • Do not use an acidic or alkaline detergent, or a cleaner containing petroleum solvent to wash aluminum wheels. These types of cleaner will cause permanent spots, discoloration and cracks on finished surfaces and damage to center caps. • Do not use a bristle brush and soap containing an abrasive material. These will damage finished surfaces. 9-3 68PH0-74E APPEARANCE CARE Washing When washing the vehicle, park it where direct sunlight does not fall on it and follow the instructions below: 1) Flush the underside of body and wheel housings with pressurized water to remove mud and debris. Use plenty of water. EXAMPLE NOTICE 60B212S WARNING • Never attempt to wash and wax your vehicle with the engine running. • When cleaning the underside of the body and fender, where there may be sharp-edged parts, you should wear gloves and a long-sleeved shirt to protect your hands and arms from being cut. • After washing your vehicle, carefully test the brakes before driving to make sure they have maintained their normal effectiveness. When washing the vehicle: • Avoid directing steam or hot water of more than 80°C (176°F) on plastic parts. • To avoid damaging engine components, do not use pressurized water in the engine compartment. 2) Rinse the body to loosen the dirt. Remove dirt and mud from the body exterior with running water. You may use a soft sponge or brush. Do not use hard materials which can scratch the paint or plastic. Remember that the headlight covers or lenses are made of plastic in many cases. NOTICE To avoid damage to the paint or plastic surface, do not wipe the dirt off without ample water. Be sure to follow above procedure. 3) Wash the entire exterior with a mild detergent or car wash soap using a sponge or soft cloth. The sponge or cloth should be frequently soaked in the soap solution. NOTICE When using a commercial car wash product, observe the cautions specified by the manufacturer. Never use strong household detergents or soaps. 4) Once the dirt has been completely removed, rinse off the detergent with running water. 5) After rinsing, wipe off the vehicle body with a wet chamois or cloth and allow it to dry in the shade. 9-4 68PH0-74E APPEARANCE CARE 6) Check carefully for damage to painted surfaces. If there is any damage, “touch-up” the damage following the procedure below: 1. Clean all damaged spots and allow them to dry. 2. Stir the paint and “touch-up” the damaged spots lightly using a small brush. 3. Allow the paint to dry completely. Waxing EXAMPLE NOTICE If you use an automatic car wash, make sure that your vehicle’s body parts, such as spoilers, cannot be damaged. If you are in doubt, consult the car wash operator for advice. 60B211S After washing the vehicle, waxing and polishing are recommended to further protect and beautify the paint. • Only use waxes and polishes of good quality. • When using waxes and polishes, observe the precautions specified by the manufacturers. 9-5 68PH0-74E GENERAL INFORMATION GENERAL INFORMATION Vehicle Identification .......................................................... 10-1 Radio Frequency Identification (RFID) Tag .......................10-2 84MM01001 10 68PH0-74E GENERAL INFORMATION Vehicle Identification also used to assist your dealer when ordering or referring to special service information. Whenever you have occasion to consult your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop, remember to identify your vehicle with this number. If you find the number difficult to read, you will also find it on the identification plate. Chassis Serial Number EXAMPLE Engine Serial Number 60G128 68PH01001 The engine serial number is stamped on the cylinder block as shown in the illustration. EXAMPLE 68PH01002 The chassis and/or engine serial numbers are used to register the vehicle. They are 10-1 68PH0-74E GENERAL INFORMATION Radio frequency identification (RFID) tag As per Ministry of Road Transport and Highways, the Radio frequency identification (RFID) tag (1) is mandatory for each vehicle for the purpose of electronic toll collection or any other purpose as may be defined by the Government of India. As seen from inside of the vehicle As seen from outside of the vehicle EXAMPLE EXAMPLE In case of any damage to RFID tag or replacement of front windscreen, please contact your nearest MARUTI SUZUKI Authorized workshop. EXAMPLE (1) 68MH1001 68MH1002 68MH1003 NOTE: The picture shown is for indicative purpose only. Internal structure of actual device mounted on vehicle may be different. NOTE: The picture shown is for indicative purpose only. Internal structure of actual device mounted on vehicle may be different. NOTE: • RFID tag needs to be registered by government authorized agency (if applicable). • Any attempt to remove the tag from the windscreen will result in permanent damage to the tag. • Use of chemical cleaners to clean the windscreen area where the tag is mounted can damage the tag. • Use of any sharp objects on the tag can damage the tag. 10-2 68PH0-74E SPECIFICATIONS SPECIFICATIONS NOTE: Specifications are subject to change without notice. M/T: Manual transaxle CVT: Continuously variable transaxle ITEM: Dimensions Overall length Overall width Overall height Wheelbase Track Petrol: Petrol engine model Diesel: Diesel engine model UNIT: mm Front Rear 3995 1745 1500 2520 1515 1505 1525 1515 170 185/65R15 tire 195/55R16 tire 185/65R15 tire 195/55R16 tire Ground clearance (Unladen condition) ITEM: Mass (weight) UNIT: kg PETROL ENGINE MODEL DIESEL ENGINE MODEL 865 – 890 960 – 985 Kerb mass (weight) M/T CVT 910 – Gross vehicle mass (weight) rating M/T 1340 1430 CVT 1360 Permissible maximum Axle Weight Front 810 Rear 760 – 11-1 68PH0-74E SPECIFICATIONS ITEM: Engine Type K12M (DOHC) D13A (DOHC) 4  Bore 73.0 mm 69.6 mm Stroke 71.5 mm 82.0 mm cm3 1248 cm3 Number of cylinders Piston displacement 1197 Compression ratio 11.0 : 1 17.6 : 1 ITEM: Electrical Standard spark plug Petrol NGK LKR6F-10 Battery Petrol 34B19L Diesel Fuses DIN55LMF or DIN50LMF See “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. 11-2 68PH0-74E SPECIFICATIONS ITEM: Lights Headlight WATTAGE BULB No. Halogen 12V 60/55W H4 Discharge 12V 25W D8S Front fog light (if equipped) 12V 35W H8 / PSX24W Position light (Vehicle with the halogen headlights) 12V 5W W5W Position light & Daytime running light (Vehicle with the discharge headlights) LED – Turn signal light Side turn signal light Front 12V 21W PY21W Rear 12V 21W PY21W (on fender) 12V 5W WY5W (on outside rearview mirror) LED – Tail/brake light LED – High mount stop light LED – Reversing light 12V 16W W16W License plate light 12V 5W W5W LED – Interior light Footwell light (if equipped) Front (if equipped) 12V 5W W5W Center 12V 10W C10W Luggage compartment (if equipped) 12V 5W W5W Glove box light (if equipped) 12V 1.4W W1.4W Courtesy light (if equipped) 12V 5W W5W 11-3 68PH0-74E SPECIFICATIONS ITEM: Wheels and Tires Tire size, front and rear 185/65R15 88S*1, 195/55R16 87H*1 Rim size 185/65R15 tire: 15X5 1/2J 195/55R16 tire: 16X6J Tire pressures For the specified tire pressure, see the Tire Information Label located on the driver’s door lock pillar. Recommended snow tire 185/65R15*2 or 195/55R16*2 Tire size, spare*3 For vehicle equipped with 195/55R16 tire 185/65R15 (steel wheel) For vehicle equipped with 185/65R15 tire 185/65R15 (steel wheel) *1 If you cannot prepare tires with the specified load index rate and speed symbol, prepare tires with higher load index rate and speed symbol. *2 If you prepare snow tires; • Make sure they are tires of the same size, structure and load capacity as the originally installed tires. • Mount the snow tires on all four wheels. • Please understand that the maximum permissible speed of snow tires is generally less than the originally installed tires. Consult your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop or supplier for further information. *3 The spare wheel provided with alloy wheel variant is of steel wheel rim, hence follow 4 tire rotation only. (Refer: Section Inspection and Maintenance) 11-4 68PH0-74E SPECIFICATIONS ITEM: Recommended Fuel/Lubricants and Capacities (approx.) Fuel See “FUEL RECOMMENDATION” section. 37 L Engine oil Petrol Classification: API SL Viscosity: SAE 0W-20 3.1 L (replacement with oil filter) Diesel Classification: ACEA A5/B5 Viscosity: SAE 5W-30 3.1 L (replacement with oil filter) Engine coolant 4.1 L (including reservoir tank) 5M/T Petrol CVT See “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. 5.9 L (including reservoir tank) Diesel Manual transaxle oil Petrol Diesel Continuously variable transmission (CVT) fluid 4.3 L (including reservoir tank) “SUZUKI GEAR OIL 75W-80” 1.5 L 2.6 L SUZUKI CVT FLUID GREEN-2 5.7 L SAE J1703 or DOT3 Refill to the proper oil level according to the instructions in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. Brake fluid / Clutch fluid 11-5 68PH0-74E SPECIFICATIONS MEMO 11-6 68PH0-74E This Owner Manual & Service Booklet applies to the BALENO series produced by MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED July, 2016 Part No. 99011M68P04-74E For 24 X 7 assistance, contact Toll Free number 1800 200 6392# © COPYRIGHT MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED 2016 Note: The illustrated model is one of the BALENO Series. (NEXA) CODE 01/07/16/5000 99011M68P04-74E Service Division MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED Palam Gurgaon Road, Gurgaon - 122 015 (Haryana) www.marutisuzuki.com OWNER’S MANUAL & SERVICE BOOKLET • Keep With Vehicle At All Times • Contains Important Information On Safety, Operation & Maintenance Part No. 99011M68P04-74E July, 2016 ENG